Yamaha RX A3040/RX A2040 Owner's Manual Web YG260B0 EN A3040 Om UCRABGLF
User Manual: Yamaha RX-A3040/RX-A2040 Owner's Manual
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 182
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
AV Receiver Owner’s Manual Read the supplied booklet “Safety Brochure” before using the unit. English CONTENTS Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 7 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 FEATURES 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 6 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . . 47 What you can do with the unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 PREPARATIONS 17 General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 1 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Basic speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Advanced speaker configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 2 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 3 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 5 Connecting a network cable or the wireless antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Connecting the network cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Connecting the wireless antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 6 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Connecting recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Connecting a device with analog multi-channel output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Selecting the connection method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Connecting the unit to a wireless network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 PLAYBACK 67 Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Selecting an HDMI output jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Selecting setting items to be included as scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD3/CINEMA DSP 3D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Setting the frequency steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 HD Radio™ tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 En 2 Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Playing back iPod music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Playback of iPod content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Playback of Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Registering favorite Internet radio stations (bookmarks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Playing back music with AirPlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . 97 Multi-zone configuration examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Preparing the multi zone system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Controlling Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142 Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . . 142 Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . . 144 ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TUNER FRQ STEP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Switching information on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Viewing the status information on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 CONFIGURATIONS 112 Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Registering the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 Registering the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Updating the unit’s firmware via the network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 En 3 APPENDIX 152 Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Power, system and remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 HDMI and video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Network information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Yamaha technologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Supported devices and file formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Multi-zone output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Audio Return Channel (ARC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Reference diagram (rear panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 En 4 Accessories Operating range of the remote control Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product. • Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the operating range shown below. Remote control Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2) Within 6 m (20 ft) 30° 30° Insert the batteries the right way round. AM antenna FM antenna *One of the above is supplied depending on the region of purchase. YPAO microphone Microphone base Pole (RX-A3040 only) • The illustrations of the main unit used in this manual are of the RX-A3040 (U.S.A. model), unless otherwise specified. *Using for angle/height measurement during YPAO. Wireless antenna Power cable CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual) Easy Setup Guide Safety Brochure *The supplied power cable varies depending on the region of purchase. • Some features are not available in certain regions. • Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice. • This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control. • This manual describes all the “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified. • indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations. • indicates supplementary explanations for better use. Accessories En 5 FEATURES What you can do with the unit Wide variety of supported content • iPod/iPhone/iPad . p.83 • USB . p.86 • Media server (PC/NAS) . p.89 • Internet radio . p.92 • AirPlay . p.95 Supports 2- to 9-channel (plus rear presence) speaker system and up to 2 subwoofer connections. Allows you to enjoy favorite acoustic spaces in various styles. • Automatically optimizing the speaker . p.47 settings to suit your room (YPAO) • Reproducing stereo or multichannel . p.71 sounds with the sound fields like actual movie theaters and concert halls (CINEMA DSP) • Enjoying compressed music with . p.75 enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) Control Network contents Speakers iPod/iPhone/iPad • Bi-amp connections, channel expansion (with external power-amp) and multi-zone configurations to enhance your system Audio . p.24 Audio USB device HDMI Control 3D and 4K Ultra HD signals supported Audio HDMI Control Audio/Video Audio/Video TV BD/DVD player Control AV receiver (the unit) Audio/Video (via HDMI/MHL) Smartphone/Tablet Sequential operation of a TV, AV receiver, and BD/DVD player (HDMI Control) Change the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) . p.68 TV remote control . p.168 FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 6 Full of useful functions! Useful tips ❑ Connecting various devices (p.38) A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks on the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players), audio devices (such as CD players), game consoles, camcorders, and other devices. ❑ Playing back TV audio in surround sound with a single HDMI cable connection (Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.35) When using an ARC-compatible TV, you only need one HDMI cable to enable video output to the TV, audio input from the TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control signals. HDMI Control TV audio Video from external device ❑ Various wireless connection methods (p.59) The unit supports the Wi-Fi feature that allows the unit to connect to your wireless router (access point) without a network cable connection. In addition, Wireless Direct enables connecting a mobile device to the unit directly without router. ❑ Surround playback with 5 speakers placed in front (p.73) If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place them in the rear of your room, you can place them in the front and enjoy multi-channel surround sound with the 5 speakers placed in the front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT). ❑ Operating external devices with the supplied remote control (p.148) I want to connect a playback device using HDMI for video and non-HDMI for audio... Use “Audio Select” in the “Option” menu to specify the type of an audio input jack to be used for the corresponding input source (p.110). Video and audio are not synchronized... Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay between video and audio output (p.129). I want to hear audio from the TV speakers... You can operate external devices with the supplied remote control by registering the remote control codes of the external devices (such as a TV and BD/DVD players). Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select the output destination of signals input into the unit (p.133). Your TV speakers may be selected as an output destination. ❑ Low power consumption (p.141) I want to get more bass sounds… The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the unit’s power consumption. Set “Extra Bass” in the “Option” menu to “On” to enjoy enhanced bass sounds (p.109). ❑ Easy operation and wireless music playback from iPhone or Android™ device I want to change the on-screen menu language... By using the application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER”, you can control the unit from an iPhone, iPad, iPod touch or Android devices. Visit the Yamaha website for details. Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a language from English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian and Chinese (p.46). I want to update the firmware... Use “FIRM UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to update the unit’s firmware (p.147). If the unit is connected to the Internet, a message will be displayed on the TV when a firmware update is available (p.151). Many other settings are available that let you to customize the unit. For details, see the following pages. • Input settings (p.112) • SCENE settings (p.114) Wi-Fi or Wireless Direct • Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.117) • Various function settings (p.121) • Information view (such as audio signal and video signal) (p.143) • System settings (p.145) FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 7 CINEMA DSP The excitement of a concert hall and the powerful sense of being inside a movie - we all want to enjoy these experiences in our own living room. Yamaha has pursued the fulfillment of these desires for more than 20 years, and this fulfillment has now taken shape as the Yamaha AV receivers. What is a sound field? CINEMA DSP/CINEMA DSP 3D We perceive sound from a voice or an instrument not only as the sounds that are heard directly but also as the “reflected” or “reverberant” sound that has been reflected by the walls or ceiling of the building. The character of the reflected and reverberant sound is affected by the shape, size, and material of the building, and all of these sounds taken together are what give us the auditory sensation of being in that specific place. Yamaha has accumulated a massive amount of acoustical data by analyzing the actual sound fields of concert halls and performance spaces around the world. “CINEMA DSP” allows this data to be applied to create sound fields. This unit contains a wide variety of sound programs using CINEMA DSP. This unique acoustical character of a specific space is what we call the “sound field”. Conceptual diagram of a concert hall's sound field By selecting a sound program that is appropriate to the content of the playback source such as movies, music, or games, you can maximize the acoustical effectiveness of that specific content. (For example, a sound program designed for movies can give you the sensation of actually being in that scene.) In addition, the “CINEMA DSP 3D” function uses 3-dimensional sound field data that includes the axis of height, generating an even more realistic sound field with a spatial sense. CINEMA DSP HD3 Capability for reproducing reflections (when the sound program “Hall in Munich” is selected) Level Conceptual diagram of a sound field created by the unit “CINEMA DSP HD³” is Yamaha's flagship 3D sound field playback technology that takes full advantage of the massive amount of acoustic reflection data included in the sound field data. With support for rear presence speaker output, it delivers more than twice as much capability for generating acoustic reflections as conventional CINEMA DSP 3D, in addition to high-frequency playback capability, delivering an utterly natural and powerful spatial sound field. CINEMA DSP HD³ CINEMA DSP 3D Time FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 8 Unrivaled audio and video quality YPAO is Yamaha original automatic calibration system to optimizing your sound and surround environment by using microphone measurement. It can be create ideal listening environment for maximizing high sound quality contents playback by adjusting various speakers setting and the sound field automatically. YPAO-R.S.C. In typical home, the sound Level has problems such as a blurred low-frequency range or a smearing of the Compensation acoustical sound image caused by undesirable Time sound reflection from the walls or ceiling. "YPAO-R.S.C." is technology that reduces only the unwanted reflections and produces the acoustic perfection for your listening environment. High-resolution music enhancer Hi-bit high-sampling extension up to 96 kHz / 24-bit can be applied to lossless 44.1/48 kHz content such as from a CD (2-channel PCM) or a FLAC file for further heightening of the musicality in the original content (p.109) Before processing Loudness YPAO Playback bandwidth of a 44.1/48 kHz signal (such as a CD) Frequency After processing High YPAO Volume ON Level YPAO Volume automatically adjusts the high and low frequency levels at any volume level so that you hear natural sounds even at low volume. Playback bandwidth of a 88.2/96 kHz signal Loudness YPAO Volume Low YPAO Volume OFF Frequency Frequency High High-quality video processing YPAO 3D measurement The direction (angle) of front, surround and presence speakers, and the height of presence speakers as seen from the listening position is measured, and compensation is applied to maximize the 3D sound field effectiveness of the CINEMA DSP. From low-quality digital video to BD (Blu-ray disc) images, any content can be played back as a high-quality image (p.131). • Motion adaptive and edge adaptive deinterlacing • Multi-cadence (including 3-2 pull-down) detection • Up to 6 presets that can be applied separately to each input source You can also apply fine touches such as detail enhancement and edge enhancement. FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 9 Expandable to meet diverse needs Support for bi-amp connections and external power amp expansion To obtain even high audio quality, you can connect front speakers that support power amp expansion, or expand your system by adding an external power amp (such as a Hi-Fi amp). For details, refer to “Advanced speaker configuration” (p.24). The best expandability in Yamaha Multi-zone function The multi-zone function (p.97) allows you to play back different input sources in the room where the unit is installed (main zone) and in other rooms (such as Zone2). (The following shows examples of use.) Enjoying music using speakers in another room While enjoying multi-channel playback in your living room, you can listen to music through the speakers of a different room. By connecting an external power amp, you can enjoy the highest peak of CINEMA DSP - an 11.2-channel 3-dimensional sound field. (Example) External power amp Study room (such as Zone2) Living room (main zone) Enjoying videos using a TV in another room (HDMI connection) While enjoying multi-channel playback in your living room, you can enjoy videos and music being input via HDMI on a TV in a different room. Kitchen (such as Zone4) Living room (main zone) FEATURES ➤ What you can do with the unit En 10 Part names and functions Front panel 1 2 6 1 MAIN ZONE z key Turns on/off (standby) the unit. 2 Standby indicator Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the following conditions. • HDMI Control is enabled (p.132) • Standby Through is enabled (p.133) • Network Standby is enabled (p.134) • An iPod is being charged (p.83) 3 7 7 Front panel door For protecting controls and jacks (p.12). 8 VOLUME knob Adjusts the volume. 4 5 8 Opening the front panel door • To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door. (Be careful not to trap your fingers.) 3 Front display Displays information (p.13). 4 Remote control sensor Receives remote control signals (p.5). 5 PURE DIRECT key Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.75). 6 INPUT knob Selects an input source. FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 11 ■ Inside of the front panel door 9 0 M 9 ON SCREEN key Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. 0 Menu operations keys Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. A OPTION key Displays the option menu (p.107). B DISPLAY key Displays status information on the TV (p.106). C TONE/BALANCE key Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of output sounds (p.108). Adjusts the left/right channel volume balance for Zone2 or Zone3 (p.102). D STRAIGHT key Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.74). E PROGRAM keys Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.70). F SCENE keys Select the registered input source, sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.68). AB C N DE F O GH IJ ZONE CONTROL L P G MULTI ZONE keys ZONE 2–4 K Enables/disables the audio output to each zone (p.101). Changes the zone that is controlled by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.101). O PHONES jack For connecting headphones. P VIDEO AUX jacks For connecting a device, such as a camcorder and a game console (p.40, 41) or a smartphone (p.41). H INFO (WPS) key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.106). Enters the wireless network connection setup (WPS push button configuration) by holding down for 3 seconds (p.61). I MEMORY key Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.77). J FM and AM keys Switch between FM and AM (p.76). K PRESET keys Select a preset FM/AM radio station (p.77). L TUNING keys Select the radio frequency (p.76). M USB jack For connecting a USB storage device (p.86) or an iPod (p.83). N YPAO MIC jack For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.47). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 12 Front display (indicators) 123 4 6 5 8 7 9 ECO MUTE VOLUME ZONE ZONE ZONE SLEEP 3 4 IN OUT 1 2 3 2 ENHANCER PARTY HD STEREO TUNED HD 3 @A B Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output. IN Lights up when HDMI signals are being input. OUT1/OUT2 Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI signal. 2 ECO Lights up when the unit is in the eco mode (p.141). 3 Signal strength indicator Indicates the strength of the wireless network signal (p.59). 4 ZONE indicators Lights up when Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 is enabled (p.101). 5 SLEEP Lights up when the sleep timer is on. 6 Information display Displays the current status (such as input name and sound mode name). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.106). Blinks when audio is muted. 8 Volume indicator Indicates the current volume. FPL L C R FPR SL SW1 SW2 SR RPL SBL SB SBR RPR C D 1 HDMI 7 MUTE ADAPTIVE DRC VIRTUAL DE 9 VIRTUAL Lights up when the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.71) or the virtual surround processing (p.73) is working. 0 ENHANCER Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.75) is working. A STEREO Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal. TUNED Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station signal. HD (U.S.A. model only) Lights up when the unit is receiving an HD Radio station signal. B CINEMA DSP indicator (RX-A3040) “CINEMA DSP HD” lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.71) is working. “CINEMA DSP !” lights up when CINEMA DSP HD³ is activated. (RX-A2040) “CINEMA DSP” lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.71) is working. “CINEMA DSP n” lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D is activated. (RX-A3040 U.S.A. model) F C PARTY Lights up when the unit is in the party mode. (p.102) D Cursor indicators Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational. E ADAPTIVE DRC Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.108) is working. F Speaker indicators Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output. A Front speaker (L) S Front speaker (R) D Center speaker F Surround speaker (L) G Surround speaker (R) H Surround back speaker (L) J Surround back speaker (R) K Surround back speaker B Front presence speaker (L) N Front presence speaker (R) M Rear presence speaker (L) < Rear presence speaker (R) C Subwoofer (1) V Subwoofer (2) FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 13 Rear panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 @ A B C D E (RX-A3040 U.S.A. model) DC OUT 5V 0.5A HDMI HDMI OUT 2 AV 1 1 (ZONE OUT) AV 2 AV 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 WIRELESS (3 NET ) AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) ARC AC IN PHONO AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV OUT MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 2 PB TRIGGER OUT PR B 1 RS-232C REMOTE IN GND 1 OUT 1 IN OUT 2 A Y PB PR Y AV 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L C AV 3 PB PR MULTI CH INPUT 12V 0.1AMAX. TOTAL CENTER ZONE OUT/PRE OUT PRE OUT (SINGLE) (FRONT) SURROUND SUR. BACK (REAR) SUBWOOFER R 1 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL FRONT 6 COAXIAL SURROUND SUR. BACK ZONE 2/ ZONE 3/ SUBWOOFER F. PRESENCE R. PRESENCE FRONT CENTER SPEAKERS R ANTENNA 75Ω FM HD Radio AM SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/R.PRESENCE R EXTRA SP2 L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/F.PRESENCE/ BI–AMP R EXTRA SP1 L (4 RADIO) * The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. SINGLE 1 PHONO jacks For connecting to a turntable (p.39). 2 DC OUT jack For connecting to an optional accessory. 3 AV 1–4 jacks For connecting to video/audio playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.38). 4 HDMI OUT 1 jack 5 AV OUT jacks For outputting video/audio to a recording device (such as a VCR) (p.44). 6 MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (component/composite video) jacks For connecting to a TV that supports component or composite video and outputting video signals (p.36) or for connecting to a zone video monitor used in Zone2 or Zone3 (p.99). For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.35). When using ARC, TV audio signal can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack. 7 COMPONENT VIDEO (AV 1–3) jacks HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack 8 HDMI (AV 1–7) jacks For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.37), or for connecting to an HDMI-compatible device used in Zone2 or Zone4 (p.99). For connecting to video playback devices that support component video and inputting video signals (p.38). For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.38). 9 TRIGGER OUT 1–2 jacks For connecting to devices that support the trigger function (p.45). 0 REMOTE IN/OUT 1–2 jacks For connecting to an infrared signal receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other devices from another room (p.100). A NETWORK jack For connecting to a network with a network cable (p.43). B RS-232C terminal This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details. C WIRELESS jack For connecting the supplied wireless antenna (p.43). D VOLTAGE SELECTOR (General model only) Selects the switch position according to your local voltage (p.45). E AC IN jack For connecting the supplied power cable (p.45). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 14 (RX-A3040 U.S.A. model) DC OUT 5V 0.5A HDMI HDMI OUT 2 AV 1 1 (ZONE OUT) AV 2 AV 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 WIRELESS (3 NET ) AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) ARC AC IN PHONO AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV OUT MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Y PB COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y AV 2 PB TRIGGER OUT PR B 1 RS-232C REMOTE IN GND 1 OUT 1 IN OUT 2 A Y PB PR Y AV 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3 AUDIO 4 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L C AV 3 PB PR MULTI CH INPUT 12V 0.1AMAX. TOTAL CENTER ZONE OUT/PRE OUT PRE OUT (SINGLE) (FRONT) SURROUND SUR. BACK (REAR) SUBWOOFER R 1 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL FRONT 6 COAXIAL SURROUND SUR. BACK ZONE 2/ ZONE 3/ SUBWOOFER F. PRESENCE R. PRESENCE FRONT CENTER SPEAKERS R ANTENNA 75Ω FM HD Radio AM SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/R.PRESENCE R EXTRA SP2 CENTER L R FRONT L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/F.PRESENCE/ BI–AMP R EXTRA SP1 L (4 RADIO) * The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. SINGLE F G F ANTENNA jacks For connecting to FM and AM antennas (p.42). G AUDIO 1–4 jacks For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting audio signals (p.39). H MULTI CH INPUT jacks For connecting to a device that supports multi-channel output and inputting audio signals (p.44). H I J I ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks (RX-A3040) For connecting to an external amplifier used in Zone2 or Zone3 and outputting audio (p.98), or for connecting to an external power amplifier for front presence or rear presence channels (p.33). ZONE OUT jacks (RX-A2040) K J SPEAKERS terminals For connecting to speakers (p.18). K PRE OUT jacks For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (p.22) or to an external power amplifier (p.33). For connecting to an external amplifier used in Zone2 or Zone3 and outputting audio (p.98). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 15 Remote control 1 Remote control signal transmitter 1 Transmits infrared signals. 2 SOURCE z key 2 Turns on/off an external device. SOURCE key Sets the remote control to operate external devices (p.149). This key lights up in green after pressed. RECEIVER key 3 Sets the remote control to operate the unit (p.149). This key lights up in orange after pressed. RECEIVER z key Turns on/off (standby) the unit. 4 5 6 7 8 G H I J K 9 Select an input source for playback. AV 1–7 AV 1–7 jacks V-AUX VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel) AUDIO 1–4 AUDIO 1–4 jacks PHONO PHONO jacks MULTI MULTI CH INPUT jacks USB USB jack (on the front panel) NET NETWORK sources (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) TUNER FM/AM radio 4 ZONE switch Changes the zone that is controlled by the remote control (p.101). L : A 5 SCENE keys Select the registered input source, sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.68). 6 PROGRAM keys B C D E F 3 Input selection keys Select a sound program (p.70). 7 External device operation keys Select menus for external devices (p.149). 8 ON SCREEN key Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. 9 Menu operation keys M Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. 0 MODE key Switches the iPod operation modes (p.85). (U.S.A. model only) Selects an HD Radio audio program (p.78). A Radio keys Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the input source (p.76). BAND Switches between FM and AM radio. PRESET Select a preset station. TUNING Select the radio frequency. External device operation keys Let you play back and perform other operations for external devices when an input source other than “TUNER” is selected (p.149). B Sound mode keys Select a sound mode (p.70). C INFO key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.106). D SLEEP key Switches the unit to standby mode automatically after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off). E Numeric keys Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies. MEMORY key Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets (p.77). F TV operation keys Let you select TV input and volume, and perform other TV operations (p.148). G HDMI OUT key Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output (p.67). H PARTY key Turns on/off the party mode (p.102). I VOLUME keys Adjust the volume. J MUTE key Mutes the audio output. K OPTION key Displays the option menu (p.107). L DISPLAY key Displays status information on the TV (p.106). M CODE SET key Registers remote control codes of external devices on the remote control (p.148). • To operate external devices with the remote control, register a remote control code for each device before using (p.148). FEATURES ➤ Part names and functions En 16 PREPARATIONS General setup procedure 1 Connecting speakers (p.18) Basic speaker configuration (p.19) Select the speaker layout and connect the speakers to the unit. Advanced speaker configuration (p.24) Apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance the system. 2 Connecting a TV (p.35) Connect a TV to the unit. 3 Connecting playback devices (p.38) Connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players) and audio devices (such as CD players) to the unit. 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.42) Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit. 5 Connecting a network cable or the wireless antenna (p.43) Connect the unit to a router (access point) with a network cable, or connect the supplied wireless antenna for establishing a wireless network connection. 6 Connecting other devices (p.44) Connect external devices such as recording devices. 7 Connecting the power cable (p.45) After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable. 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language (p.46) Select the desired on-screen menu language. 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) (p.47) Optimize the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room (YPAO). 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly (p.59) Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point) or a mobile device by establishing a wireless connection. This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit! PREPARATIONS ➤ General setup procedure En 17 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 Connecting speakers The unit has 9 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 11 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system (p.24). Caution • Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.22). Ideal speaker layout Functions of each speaker Speaker type Abbr. Function Front (L) 1 Front (R) 2 Center 3 Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogues and vocals). Surround (L) 4 Surround (R) 5 Produce surround left/right channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when no surround back speakers are connected. Surround back (L) 6 Surround back (R) 7 Front presence (L) E Front presence (R) R Rear presence (L) T Rear presence (R) Y Subwoofer 9 E R 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) Produce front left/right channel sounds (stereo sounds). 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 1 9 2 3 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 9 Produce surround back left/right channel sounds. Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP HD³ (RX-A3040) or CINEMA DSP 3D (RX-A2040) (p.71), the presence speakers create a natural 3-dimensional sound field in your room. 4 5 10°~30° Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces bass parts of other channels. This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers to the unit and place them on the left/right (or front/rear) sides of the room. 10°~30° T • Use “Ideal speaker layout” (diagram on the right) as reference. You do not need to exactly adjust the speaker layout to this diagram since the YPAO function of the unit will automatically optimize the speaker settings (such as distances) to suit the speaker layout. 6 • When using only one surround back speaker, place it straight behind the listening position (middle of “SBL” and “SBR” in the diagram). • The unit creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce 3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected. However, we recommend using front presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of the sound fields (and rear presence speakers for further spatial sounds). Y 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 7 0.3 m (1 ft) or more 1.8 m (5.9 ft) • (RX-A3040 only) The unit creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce natural 3-dimensional sound fields when front presence speakers are connected but no rear presence speakers. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 18 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Basic speaker configuration ■ Placing speakers in your room Depending on the number of speakers, place the speakers and subwoofer in your room. This section describes the representative speaker layout examples. ❑ 9.2+2-channel system (using both surround back and rear presence speakers) E R 1 9 E 2 3 R 1 9 4 9 5 T Y 6 ❑ 9.2-channel system (using rear presence speakers) 4 T 2 3 9 5 Y 7 This speaker system brings out the full performance of the unit and allows you to enjoy a highly-natural 3-dimensional sound field with any contents. This speaker system uses the front and rear presence speakers to produce a highly-natural 3-dimensional sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents. • The surround back speakers and rear presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the selected sound program (p.71). • When using front presence and rear presence speakers installed to the ceiling, set “Layout (Front Presence/Rear Presence)” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu to “Overhead” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. • When using front presence and rear presence speakers installed to the ceiling, set “Layout (Front Presence/Rear Presence)” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu to “Overhead” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. • (RX-A3040 only) You can make an 11-channel system by using an external power amplifier (p.25). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 19 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 9.2-channel system (using surround back speakers) E ❑ 7.1-channel system (using front presence speakers) R 1 9 2 3 9 4 5 6 7 This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional sound field, and also allows you to enjoy extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers. • When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling, set “Layout (Front Presence)” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu to “Overhead” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. • (RX-A3040 only) This speaker system creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional sound field. This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents. • When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling, set “Layout (Front Presence)” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu to “Overhead” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. • (RX-A3040 only) This speaker system creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional sound field. ❑ 7.1-channel system (using surround back speakers) This speaker system creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a 3-dimensional sound field, and also allows you to enjoy extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 5.1-channel system ❑ Front 5.1-channel system (using front presence speakers) This speaker system creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce a 3-dimensional sound field, and is suited for enjoying 5.1-channel contents. This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional sound field, and creates the virtual surround speakers using the front speakers to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound (Virtual CINEMA DSP). • When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling, set “Layout (Front Presence)” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu to “Overhead” after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. ❑ Front 5.1-channel system (using surround speakers) 4 ❑ 2.1-channel system 5 9 Even when surround speakers are placed in the front side, the unit creates the virtual surround speakers in the rear side to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound (Virtual CINEMA FRONT) when “Layout (Surround)” (p.126) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”. Even when no surround speakers are connected, the unit creates the virtual surround speakers using the front speakers to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound (Virtual CINEMA DSP). • You can enjoy surround sound even without the center speaker (front 4.1-channel system). • Add the center speaker to configure a 3.1-channel system. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 21 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Setting the speaker impedance ■ Connecting speakers Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When using a 6-ohm speaker for any channel, set the speaker impedance to “6 MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit. 1 Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet. 2 While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z Caution • Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before connecting the speakers. • Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on. Speakers to be connected STRAIGHT Room 3 Check that “SPEAKER IMP.” is displayed on the front display. SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 4 5 SPEAKERIMP. 8MIN MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Press STRAIGHT to select “6 MIN”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the power cable from the AC wall outlet. You are now ready to connect the speakers. Main zone Speaker type Speaker system (the number of channels) Abbr. 9+2 9 7 5 2 Front (L) 1 ● ● ● ● ● Front (R) 2 ● ● ● ● ● Center 3 ● ● ● ● Surround (L) 4 ● ● ● *5 Surround (R) 5 ● ● ● *5 Surround back (L) 6 ● *1 *3 Surround back (R) 7 ● *1 *3 Front presence (L) E ● ● *4 *6 Front presence (R) R ● ● *4 *6 Rear presence (L) T ● *2 Rear presence (R) Y ● *2 Power Amp Assign (p.124) Basic (default) If you have nine speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*1) or rear presence speakers (*2). If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*3) or front presence speakers (*4). If you have five speakers, use two of them as surround speakers (*5) or front presence speakers (*6). • You can also connect up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit. When using 2 subwoofers, configure the “Layout (Subwoofer)” setting (p.127) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. • To use an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to enhance speaker output, see “Connecting an external power amplifier” (p.33). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Cables necessary for connection (commercially available) ❑ Connecting speaker cables Speaker cables (x the number of speakers) Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit and the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to prevent confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal. + – + – Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers) a Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable, and twist the bare wires of the cable firmly together. Connection diagram b Loosen the speaker terminal. Refer to the following diagram and connect the speakers to the unit. c Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the terminal. d Tighten the terminal. The unit (rear) + (red) + b c FR ON T - a d – (black) Using a banana plug (U.S.A., Canada, Australia and General models only) a Tighten the speaker terminal. E R 1 b Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal. 2 a Banana plug 9 3 + FR ON T 9 b 4 5 ❑ Connecting the subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer. T Y Audio pin cable 6 7 PRE OUT (SING LE) (FR ONT) 1 2 SURR UND SUR. BACK (RE SUBW AR) OOFE R CENT CENT ER ER FRO NT • When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 23 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Advanced speaker configuration In addition to the basic speaker configuration (p.19), the unit also allows you to apply the following speaker configurations to enhance your system. Using the four internal amplifiers for front speakers to have more high-quality sounds Bi-amp connection Combining with an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, multi-channel amplifier, etc.) to build an extended system Using the excess internal amplifiers for stereo speakers in another room Power-amp channel expansion (Example) Multi-zone configuration (Example) (Example) External power amplifier Bi-amp connection Zone2 Main zone PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 24 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Available speaker configurations (RX-A3040) Main zone Speaker configuration Output channel (max) Bi-amp Using a bi-amp connection in the main zone 7 Using a bi-amp connection in the main zone and multi-zone speakers 7 Using a bi-amp connection in the main zone and power-amp channel expansion (for presence channels) Using power-amp channel expansion (for front and/or presence channels) Using power-amp channel expansion (for front channels) and multi-zone speakers 11 External power amplifier (required) Power Amp Assign (p.124) Page 7ch BI-AMP 26 +1 room 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE 26 7ch BI-AMP +FP+RP 27 Front presence Rear presence 11 Rear Presence 9ch +RP 27 11 Front 9ch +FRONT 28 11 Front presence Rear presence 7ch +FP+RP 28 9 Front +1 room 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE 29 7 Front +2 rooms 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE 29 +1 room 7ch +1ZONE 30 9 +1 room 9ch +1ZONE 30 7 +2 rooms 7ch +2ZONE 31 Multi-zone Power Amp Assign (p.124) Page 7ch BI-AMP 26 +1 room 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE 26 29 7 Using multi-zone speakers Multi-zone (RX-A2040) Main zone Speaker configuration Output channel (max) Bi-amp External power amplifier (required) Using a bi-amp connection in the main zone 7 Using a bi-amp connection in the main zone and multi-zone speakers 7 Using power-amp channel expansion (for front channels) and multi-zone speakers 9 Front +1 room 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE 7 Front +2 rooms 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE 29 +1 room 7ch +1ZONE 30 9 +1 room 9ch +1ZONE 30 7 +2 rooms 7ch +2ZONE 31 7 Using multi-zone speakers • When applying one of these configurations, you need to configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124) in the “Setup” menu. • When applying a multi-zone configuration, you can select a zone (Zone2 or Zone3) to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 1–2 jacks in “Power Amp Assign” (p.124) in the “Setup” menu. By default, Zone2 is assigned to the EXTRA SP 1 jacks and Zone3 is assigned to the EXTRA SP 2 jacks. The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the default zone assignments. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 25 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 7ch BI-AMP ❑ 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE Bi-amp 1 9 Bi-amp 1 2 3 9 9 4 5 2 2 9 3 4 5 6 6 1 7 7 Zone3 Main zone Speaker Connect to Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection) 12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection) 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK 67 SURROUND BACK ER (not used) ER (not used) TY (not used) TY (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 Zone3 speakers EXTRA SP 2 • When Zone3 output is enabled (p.101), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 26 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 7ch BI-AMP +FP+RP (RX-A3040 only) ❑ 9ch +RP (RX-A3040 only) Bi-amp E R 1 R 2 3 9 1 9 4 Speaker 7 9 4 Y 6 2 3 9 5 T via external amp E via external amp via external amp 5 T via external amp via external amp Connect to Y 6 Speaker 7 Connect to 12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection) 12 FRONT 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK 67 SURROUND BACK ER F.PRESENCE (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier ER EXTRA SP 1 TY R.PRESENCE (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier TY R.PRESENCE (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 • When this configuration is applied, you cannot utilize the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks for connecting external amplifiers for Zone2 and Zone3 (p.98). via external amp • When this configuration is applied, you cannot utilize the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks for connecting an external amplifier for Zone3 (p.98). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 27 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 9ch +FRONT (RX-A3040 only) ❑ 7ch +FP+RP (RX-A3040 only) via external amp E R E R via external amp via external amp 1 2 3 9 1 9 4 T Speaker 7 9 4 Y 6 3 9 5 2 5 T via external amp Connect to Y 6 Speaker 7 Connect to 12 FRONT (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier 12 FRONT 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK 67 SURROUND BACK ER EXTRA SP 1 ER F.PRESENCE (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier TY EXTRA SP 2 TY R.PRESENCE (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 • When this configuration is applied, you cannot utilize the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks for connecting an external amplifier for Zone3 (p.98). via external amp • When this configuration is applied, you cannot utilize the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks for connecting external amplifiers for Zone2 and Zone3 (p.98). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 28 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE ❑ 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE via external amp via external amp E R 1 9 2 1 9 3 4 9 5 6 1 2 1 2 9 3 4 7 5 6 2 Zone2 7 1 Zone3 2 Main zone Main zone Zone3 Speaker Connect to Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier 12 FRONT (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK 67 SURROUND BACK ER EXTRA SP 1 ER (not used) TY (not used) TY (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 Zone3 speakers EXTRA SP 2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP 1 Zone3 speakers EXTRA SP 2 PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 29 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 7ch +1ZONE ❑ 9ch +1ZONE E 1 9 2 1 4 9 2 1 5 6 7 7 Zone3 Zone2 Main zone Speaker 2 9 3 4 5 6 1 2 9 3 R Main zone Connect to Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT 12 FRONT 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK 67 SURROUND BACK ER (not used) ER EXTRA SP 1 TY (not used) TY (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP 1 Zone3 speakers EXTRA SP 2 • When Zone3 output is enabled (p.101), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 30 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ 7ch +2ZONE 1 9 1 2 9 3 4 5 6 2 Zone2 7 1 2 Main zone Zone3 Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK ER (not used) TY (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1–2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP 1 Zone3 speakers EXTRA SP 2 • When Zone3 output is enabled (p.101), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 31 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections ■ Connecting Zone2/3 speakers When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the FRONT terminals and EXTRA SP 1 terminals. When using Zone2/3 speakers, connect them to the EXTRA SP 1–2 terminals. To enable the bi-amp function, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. To utilize the EXTRA SP 1–2 terminals for Zone2/3 speakers, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124) in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet. The unit (rear) The unit (rear) 1 1 4 1 2 3 2 4 3 9 2 9 5 6 7 Zone2 5 Main zone 1 2 Zone3 • The FRONT terminals and EXTRA SP 1 terminals output the same signals. Caution • Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables. • You can select a zone (Zone2 or Zone3) to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 1–2 jacks in “Power Amp Assign” (p.124) in the “Setup” menu. By default, Zone2 is assigned to the EXTRA SP 1 jacks and Zone3 is assigned to the EXTRA SP 2 jacks. • You can also connect Zone2 and Zone3 speakers using an external amplifier (p.98). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 32 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Connecting an external power amplifier When connecting an external power amplifier to enhance speaker output, connect the input jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit. The same channel signals are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. (Example) Connecting front speakers via an external power amplifier PRE OUT (FRONT) jacks Main input jack Caution MAIN IN PR • To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making connections. L L R R – Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them. – When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. – When using a pre-main amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, turn up the volume of the pre-main amplifier enough and fix it. In this case, do not connect other devices (except the unit) to the pre-main amplifier. FRONT Amplifier with volume control bypass (such as A-S3000) SUR The unit (rear) 1 23 45 6 The unit (rear) 1 F.PRESENCE jacks (RX-A3040 only) Output front presence channel audio signals or Zone2 audio signals depending on the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124). 2 R.PRESENCE jacks (RX-A3040 only) Output rear presence channel audio signals or Zone3 audio signals depending on the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124). 3 FRONT jacks Output front channel sounds. About external power amplifiers We recommend using power amplifiers that meet the following conditions. • With unbalanced inputs • With volume control bypass (or without volume control circuit) • Output power: 100 W or more (6 to 8 ) 4 SURROUND jacks Output surround channel sounds. 5 SUR. BACK jacks Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one surround back speaker, connect the external amplifier to the SINGLE jack (L side). 6 CENTER jack Outputs center channel sounds. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting speakers En 33 Input/output jacks and cables ■ Video/audio jacks ■ Video jacks ■ Audio jacks ❑ HDMI jacks ❑ COMPONENT VIDEO jacks ❑ OPTICAL jacks Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single jack. Use an HDMI cable. Transmit video signals separated into three components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB), and chrominance red (PR). Use a component video cable with three plugs. Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before using the cable. AV 1 HDMI cable Digital optical cable EN PON COM Component video cable AV 1 A • Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using a cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality degradation. ❑ COAXIAL jacks ❑ VIDEO jacks • The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return Channel (ARC), and 3D and 4K Ultra HD video transmission features. Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable. AV 1 Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial cable. Digital coaxial cable Video pin cable • Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K Ultra HD videos. ❑ HDMI/MHL jack Transmits digital video and digital sound. Use an MHL or HDMI cable. ❑ AUDIO jacks Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin cable (RCA cable). MHL or HDMI cable Stereo pin cable • The VIDEO AUX jack on the front panel of the unit supports both MHL and HDMI connections. Use a cable that matches the jack on your MHL-compatible mobile device. For details on an MHL connection, see “MHL connection” (p.41). When connecting an HDMI-compatible playback device to the VIDEO AUX jack, use an HDMI cable. PREPARATIONS ➤ Input/output jacks and cables En 34 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 Connecting a TV Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV. You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit. To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the HDMI settings on the unit. For details on the settings, see “Information on HDMI” (p.168). To maximize the performance of the unit, we recommend connecting a TV with an HDMI cable. About Audio Return Channel (ARC) ■ HDMI connection • When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC. • ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways. If you connect a TV that supports ARC to the unit with a single HDMI cable, you can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit. Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable). • You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.37). HDMI OUT jack The unit (rear) HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) 1 ARC HDMI HDMI input HDMI HDMI AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L L L R R R TV 5 OPTICAL OPTICAL O AUDIO 1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks O Audio output (digital optical or analog stereo) • You do not make an audio cable connection between the TV and the unit in the following cases: – If your TV supports Audio Return Channel (ARC) – If you will receive TV broadcasts only from the set-top box • If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s power and volume with the TV’s remote control. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 35 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Component/composite video connection ❑ VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable) When connecting any video device with a component video cable, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks. When connecting any video device with a video pin cable, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack. The unit (rear) MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Video input (composite video) VIDEO V • If you connect your TV to the unit with a cable other than HDMI, video input to the unit via HDMI cannot be output to the TV. • Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. V AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L L L R R R • If you will receive TV broadcasts only from the set-top box, you do not need to make an audio cable connection between the TV and the unit. TV 5 OPTICAL ❑ COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable) OPTICAL O MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks The unit (rear) MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Y PB PR AUDIO 1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks O Audio output (digital optical or analog stereo) PR PB Video input (component video) Y COMPONENT VIDEO PR Y PB PR PB Y AUDIO AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L L L R R R TV 5 OPTICAL OPTICAL O AUDIO 1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks O Audio output (digital optical or analog stereo) PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 36 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Connecting another TV or a projector HDMI The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching videos with the remote control (p.67). The unit (rear) HDMI OUT 2 jack HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) 1 ARC TV HDMI HDMI input HDMI Projector TV (already connected) • HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack. • If you set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2” or “Zone4”, you can connect a video monitor for Zone2 or Zone4 to the HDMI OUT 2 jack and enjoy videos and audio using the video monitor (p.99). PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a TV En 37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 3 Connecting playback devices The unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect an iPod or a USB storage device, see the following pages. • Connecting an iPod (p.83) ■ Component video connection Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. • Connecting a USB storage device (p.86) Output jacks on video device Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles to the unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device, choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack. • Videos input to the unit via HDMI cannot be output to a TV connected to the unit with a cable other than HDMI. For details, refer to “Video signal flow” (p.166). • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting (p.138) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COMPONENT VIDEO (A , B , C ), COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL (c, d, e) jacks to another input source. Input jacks on the unit Video Audio Component video Digital coaxial AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical AV 3 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV 1–3 (COMPONENT VIDEO + AUDIO) AV 1–3 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks The unit (rear) Y PB PR PR PB Y Video output (component video) • If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.110) in the “Option” menu. ■ HDMI connection PR Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable. The unit (rear) Y PB PR PB Y HDMI (AV 1–7) jacks C C COAXIAL O L HDMI output Video device O L L R R OPTICAL HDMI HDMI R HDMI Any of AV 1–2 (COAXIAL), AV 3 (OPTICAL), AV 1–3 (AUDIO) jacks Video device Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–3 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–7 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 38 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ■ Composite video connection Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. Connect audio devices such as CD players, MD players, and a turntable to the unit. Depending on the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following connections. Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit Video Audio Composite video Digital coaxial AV 1–2 (VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical AV 3–4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV 1–4 (VIDEO + AUDIO) • The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting (p.138) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COAXIAL (a, b, f) and OPTICAL (c, d, e) jacks to another input source. • If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.110) in the “Option” menu. The unit (rear) AV 1–4 (VIDEO) jacks Video output (composite video) V VIDEO V C Audio output jacks on the unit Digital coaxial AV 1–2 (COAXIAL) AUDIO 2 (COAXIAL) Digital optical AV 3–4 (OPTICAL) AUDIO 1 (OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV 1–4 (AUDIO) AUDIO 1–4 (AUDIO) Turntable (PHONO) PHONO C COAXIAL O Audio output jacks on audio device Video device O L L L R R OPTICAL R Any of AV 1–2 (COAXIAL), AV 3–4 (OPTICAL), AV 1–4 (AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–4 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 39 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel PHONO jacks PHONO Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect a playback device to the unit. Audio output (PHONO) Ground lead GND Use the USB jack to connect an iPod or a USB storage device. For details, see “Connecting an iPod” (p.83) or “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.86). GND The unit (rear) Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on the unit. PHONO L L L L R R ❑ HDMI connection R R Turntable Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as game consoles and camcorders) to the unit with an HDMI cable. HDMI C C COAXIAL O Audio device The unit (front) O L L L R R OPTICAL R Any of AV 1–4, AUDIO 1–4 (COAXIAL, OPTICAL, AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) Game console If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–4, AUDIO 1–4 or PHONO on the remote control, the audio played back on the audio device will be output from the unit. When connecting a turntable • The PHONO jack of the unit is compatible with an MM cartridge. To connect a turntable with a low-output MC cartridge, use a boosting transformer. Camcorder If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. • Connecting the turntable to the GND terminal of the unit may reduce noise in the signal. • To watch videos input to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI/MHL IN) jack, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the unit (p.35). • You need to prepare an HDMI cable that matches the output jacks on your device. • When “USB” is selected as the input source, video signals input to the VIDEO AUX jacks are output from the HDMI OUT and MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jacks by default. You can change the video out setting in “Video Out” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 40 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ MHL connection ❑ Composite video/analog stereo connection Connect an MHL-compatible mobile device (such as smartphones) to the unit with an MHL cable. You can enjoy full HD videos and multichannel audio sources stored on the mobile device. The VIDEO AUX (HDMI/MHL IN) jack of the unit enables you to input videos and audio directly from the mobile device to the unit. Connect a playback device (such as game consoles and camcorders) to the unit with a video pin cable and a stereo pin cable. V L R MHL The unit (front) The unit (front) MHL output MHL Game console Mobile device If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played back on the mobile device will be output from the unit. Camcorder • To watch videos input to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI/MHL IN) jack, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the unit (p.35). • You need to prepare an MHL cable that matches the jack on your mobile device. If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. • If you cannot hear sounds played on the mobile device, check the volume of the mobile device. • You can operate the mobile device using the menu operation keys, external device operation keys and numeric keys on the remote control. However, some features may not be compatible, depending on the mobile device or its application. In this case, operate the mobile device itself. • If you connect video devices to both the VIDEO AUX (HDMI/MHL IN) jack and VIDEO AUX (VIDEO/AUDIO) jacks, the unit outputs video/audio input through the VIDEO AUX (HDMI/MHL IN) jack. • If “Standby Through” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, you can output mobile device videos/audio to the TV or operate the mobile device using the remote control of the unit even when the unit is in standby mode. • The unit supplies power to the mobile device in the following conditions. – The unit is turned on. – The unit is in standby mode while “Standby Through” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting playback devices En 41 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 4 Connecting the FM/AM antennas Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit. Assembling the AM antenna Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface. • The location of the antenna jacks varies depending on the region of purchase. FM antenna AM antenna Connecting the AM antenna Hold down The unit (rear) Insert Release • Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit. • The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting the FM/AM antennas En 42 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 5 Connecting a network cable or the wireless antenna Connect the unit to a router (access point) with a network cable, or connect the supplied wireless antenna for establishing a wireless network connection. Connecting the wireless antenna You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and Network Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit. Connect the supplied wireless antenna to the unit for establishing a wireless network connection. For information on how to connect the unit to a network device wirelessly, see “Connecting to a network device wirelessly” (p.59). Connecting the network cable Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5 or higher straight cable). Internet Network Attached Storage (NAS) WAN b ESS WIREL LAN a Modem PC a Rotate the antenna clockwise. Network cable The unit (rear) b Stand the antenna up straight. Router Mobile device (such as iPod touch and iPhone) • Do not connect the antenna other than the supplied one. • Do not apply excessive force on the antenna. Doing so may damage it. • When packing the unit, remove the antenna to prevent damage. • If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit, as the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to configure the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network parameters manually (p.134). • You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. • Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router) may block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the security software or firewall settings appropriately. • Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit. • To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting a network cable or the wireless antenna En 43 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 6 Connecting other devices Connecting recording devices Connecting a device with analog multi-channel output You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT jacks. These jacks output video/audio signals selected as the input. You can connect an analog multi-channel output device such as a DVD player and an SACD player to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. The unit (rear) • The AV OUT jacks cannot output video/audio signals input through the HDMI or COMPONENT VIDEO jacks. • Be sure to use the AV OUT jacks only for connecting recording devices. AV OUT jacks The unit (rear) AV OUT Video/audio input VIDEO V MULTI CH INPUT Channel output (Center) CENTER V AUDIO (Subwoofer) L L L R R R Video/audio recording device FRONT MULTI CH INPUT jacks SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER L (Surround back) R OPTICAL L O O (Surround) Device with analog multi-channel output R L (Front) R If you select “MULTI CH” as the input source by pressing MULTI on the remote control, the audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. • You can select a video source to be displayed when “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source using “Video Out” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. When connecting a video device (such as a DVD player) to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks, use the input jack specified in “Video Out” for the video connection. • Since the unit does not redirect signals input to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers, make appropriate settings on the external device (such as a DVD player) that suit to the speaker configuration. • When “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source, sound mode selection and tone control adjustment are not available. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting other devices En 44 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the unit (such as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the trigger function by connecting the external device to one of the TRIGGER OUT jacks. The unit (rear) TRIGGER OUT 1–2 jacks Trigger In (+12V) 7 Connecting the power cable Before connecting the power cable (General model only) Set the switch position of VOLTAGE SELECTOR according to your local voltage. Voltages are AC 110–120/220–240 V, 50/60 Hz. Power amplifier (such as MX-A5000) • Make sure you set VOLTAGE SELECTOR of the unit BEFORE plugging the power cable into an AC wall outlet. Improper setting of VOLTAGE SELECTOR may cause damage to the unit and create a potential fire hazard. TRIGGER OUT 1 The unit (rear) 2 12V VOLTAGE SELECTOR 0.1AMAX. TOTAL VOLTAGE SELECTOR 220V240V 110V120V System connection input Yamaha subwoofer • You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output1” and “Trigger Output2” (p.139) in the “Setup” menu. After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to the unit and then to an AC wall outlet. The unit (rear) To an AC wall outlet PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting the power cable En 45 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z 8 Selecting an on-screen menu language Select the desired on-screen menu language from English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian and Chinese. ON SCREEN 1 2 Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. 3 4 Press ON SCREEN. 5 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and the cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired language. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit. 6 7 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. • The information on the front display is provided in English only. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Cursor keys ENTER PREPARATIONS ➤ Selecting an on-screen menu language En 46 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to your listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room. 4 According to your speaker configuration, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124) in the “Setup” menu. For the basic speaker configuration (p.19): set to “Basic” (default). For any of the advanced speaker configurations (p.24): set to the appropriate setting. • The YPAO function of the unit adopts the YPAO-R.S.C. (Reflected Sound Control) technology that enables to create natural sound fields like a room specifically designed for acoustic perfection. 5 • Note the following regarding YPAO measurement. – Test tones are output at high volume and may surprise or frighten small children. Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position and connect it to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel. – Test tone volume cannot be adjusted. – Keep the room as quiet as possible. – Stay in a corner of the room behind the listening position so that you do not become an obstacle between speakers and the YPAO microphone. – Do not connect headphones. 1 2 3 • Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position (same height as your ears). We recommend the use of a tripod as a microphone stand. You can use the tripod screws to stabilize the microphone. YPAO MIC jack Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. The unit (front) YPAO MIC Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit. Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If the crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to maximum. VOLUME CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT E 1 9 MAX MIN 2 3 9 4 MIN R YPAO 5 microphone MAX Ear height PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 47 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ Multi Position The following screen appears on the TV. RECEIVER Selects multi measure or single measure. Settings • To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting the measurement. 6 Cursor keys ENTER If desired, select the measuring options. Yes Select this option if you will have several listening positions or if you want others to enjoy surround sound. You can take measurements at up to 8 different positions in the room. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit the area defined by those positions (multi measure). No (default) Select this option if your listening position will always be fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position (single measure). a Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” (p.48) or “Angle/Height” (p.49) (RX-A3040 only) and press ENTER. b Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER. • If the cursor keys do not work, the remote control may be set to operate external devices. In this case, press RECEIVER and then use the cursor keys. This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the measurement. • If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to enjoy surround sound in a wider space. • If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the listening position you will be seated most frequently. When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”: “Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.53) When “Multi Position” is set to “No”: “Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.50) PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 48 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Single measure Multi measure (5 listening positions) ❑ Angle/Height (RX-A3040 only) Enables/disables the angle/height measurement. a d e bac Settings Multi measure Multi measure (1 listening position + front/back/left/right) (2 listening positions + front/back) b c a e d Yes Enables the angle/height measurement. The unit will measure angle of each speaker and height of the presence speakers at the listening position, and correct the speaker parameters so that CINEMA DSP can create more effective sound fields. No (default) Disables the angle/height measurement. c a b d PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 49 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) (RX-A3040 [when angle/height measurement is enabled]) Proceed to Step 2. When “Multi Position” is set to “No”, follow the procedure below for measurement. It takes about 5 minutes to perform the measurement. • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.57) or “Warning messages” (p.58). • (RX-A3040 only) Do not use the microphone base until the corresponding message appear on the TV. 1 Cursor keys ENTER RETURN To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. 2 The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. Perform the angle/height measurement. a Use the cursor keys to select “YES” and press ENTER. Select “NO” to cancel the angle/height measurement. b Attach the supplied pole to the center of the microphone base. Pole • To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement finishes. (RX-A2040) (RX-A3040 [when angle/height measurement is disabled]) Microphone base Proceed to Step 3. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 50 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 f Set the YPAO microphone at the top of the pole and perform the fourth angle measurement. c Place the microphone base at the listening position and set the YPAO microphone to the position “1”. Microphone base The following screen appears on the TV when the fourth angle measurement finishes. ENTER • We recommend using a tripod to place the microphone base at ear height. Use the tripod screws to fix the microphone base in place. • Do not move the microphone base until the fourth angle measurement finishes. 3 Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press ENTER. d Press ENTER to start the first angle measurement. The following screen appears on the TV when the first angle measurement finishes. • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.55). e In the same way, perform the angle measurement for the positions “2” and “3”. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 51 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 4 To save the measurement results, use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. Caution • The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). The adjusted speaker settings are applied. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. Cursor keys ENTER 5 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER. • If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural sounds even at low volume. • You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.108) in the “Option” menu. 6 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. This completes optimization of the speaker settings. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 52 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) 3 When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for measurement. It takes about 15 minutes to measure 8 listening positions. When the measurements at the positions you want to measure are completed, use the cursor keys to select “CANCEL” and press ENTER. When you have taken measurements at 8 listening positions, the following screen appears automatically. (RX-A2040) • If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.57) or “Warning messages” (p.58). • (RX-A3040 only) Do not use the microphone base until the corresponding message appear on the TV. 1 (RX-A3040 [when angle/height measurement is disabled]) Proceed to Step 5. To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the measurement immediately. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN • To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement at the first position finishes. 2 (RX-A3040 [when angle/height measurement is enabled]) Proceed to Step 4. Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening position and press ENTER. Repeat Step 2 until measurements at all listening positions (up to 8) have been taken. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 53 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 4 d Press ENTER to start the first angle measurement. Perform the angle/height measurement. a Use the cursor keys to select “YES” and press ENTER. The following screen appears on the TV when the first angle measurement finishes. Select “NO” to cancel the angle/height measurement. b Attach the supplied pole to the center of the microphone base. Pole e In the same way, perform the angle measurement for the positions “2” and “3”. Microphone base Cursor keys ENTER c Place the microphone base at the listening position you will be seated most frequently and set the YPAO microphone to the position “1”. Microphone base f Set the YPAO microphone at the top of the pole and perform the fourth angle measurement. The following screen appears on the TV when the fourth angle measurement finishes. • We recommend using a tripod to place the microphone base at ear height. Use the tripod screws to fix the microphone base in place. • Do not move the microphone base until the fourth angle measurement finishes. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 54 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 5 Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press ENTER. • To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.55). 6 To save the measurement result, use the cursor keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. 8 Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. This completes optimization of the speaker settings. Caution • The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). Checking the measurement results You can check the YPAO measurement results. 1 After the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Result” and press ENTER. Cursor keys ENTER • You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.121) in the “Setup” menu, which displays the previous measurement results. The adjusted speaker settings are applied. The following screen appears. • To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. 7 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER. 1 2 3 1 Measurement result items 2 Measurement result details 3 The number of measured positions (when multi measure is performed) • If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural sounds even at low volume. • You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.108) in the “Option” menu. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 55 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments Use the cursor keys to select an item. Wiring Polarity of each speaker Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Size Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the subwoofer) Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker Level Output level adjustment for each speaker When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings and reload the previous YPAO adjustments. 1 In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto Setup”, and then “Result” (p.120). 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload‘” and press ENTER. 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. (RX-A3040 only) Angle (Horizontal) Horizontal angle of each speaker at the listening position ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Height 3 (RX-A3040 only) Height of the presence speakers above the level of the listening position To finish checking the results and return to the previous screen, press RETURN. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 56 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Error messages If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again. Error message Cause Remedy E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected. E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected. E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the front presence speakers cannot be detected. E-4: SBR → SBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only. When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker. E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud. Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select “PROCEED”, YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected. E-6: Check Sur. Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround speakers are connected. Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers. E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”. E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. E-11: No R.PRNS SP One of the rear presence speakers cannot be detected. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 57 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Warning messages If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions. However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings. Warning message Cause Remedy W-1: Out of Phase A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.56) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by “Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly: Turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable. If the speaker is connected correctly: Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are connected correctly. In this case, you can ignore the message. W-2: Over Distance A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening position. Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.55) and move the speaker identified by “>24.00m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft) of the listening position. W-3: Level Error There are significant volume differences between the speakers. Select “Level” in “Result” (p.56) and check the speaker identified by “Over ±10.0dB”, then check the usage environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as possible. PREPARATIONS ➤ Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 58 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point) or a mobile device by establishing a wireless connection. ■ Connecting without a wireless router (access point) Connect a mobile device to the unit directly. You can use the application for smartphone / tablet “AV CONTROLLER” to control the unit from mobiles devices or enjoy music files stored on mobiles devices on the unit. Selecting the connection method Select a connection method according to your network environment. ■ Connecting with a wireless router (access point) Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point). You can enjoy Internet radio, AirPlay, or music files stored on media servers (PC/NAS) on the unit. Internet Mobile device (such as iPhone) The unit For details on connection, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct)” (p.65). Wireless router • You cannot use Wireless Direct simultaneously with the wired (network cable) connection (p.43) or the wireless network connection (p.60). Modem • When Wireless Direct is enabled, the following functions are not available. – Internet radio – Network services – Playback of music stored on media servers (PC/NAS) Mobile device (such as iPhone) The unit • For details on “AV CONTROLLER”, visit the Yamaha website. For details on connection, see “Connecting the unit to a wireless network” (p.60). • You cannot use the wireless network connection simultaneously with the wired (network cable) connection (p.43) or Wireless Direct (p.65). • If the unit and the wireless router (access point) are too far apart, the unit may not connect to a wireless router (access point). In such case, place them close to each other. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 59 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z Connecting the unit to a wireless network There are several methods to connect the unit to a wireless network. Select a connection method according to your environment. Do you own iOS devices (iPhone/iPad/iPod touch)? Yes A (p.60) No Does your wireless router (access point) has a WPS button? 4 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. 7 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless (Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Connection” and press ENTER. Yes B (p.61) ON SCREEN No Cursor keys ENTER C (p.62) ■ A: Sharing the iOS device setting You can easily setup a wireless connection by applying the connection settings on iOS devices (iPhone/iPad/iPod touch). Before proceeding, confirm that your iOS device is connected to a wireless router. • The checkmark indicates the current setting. 8 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Share Wi-Fi Settings (iOS)” and select “NEXT”. • You need iOS device with iOS 5.0 or later. For details on supported devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.165). 1 2 Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). • Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. 3 Press ON SCREEN. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 60 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z 9 Connect the iOS device to the USB jack, and disable the screen lock on the iOS device. The unit (front) ■ B: Using the WPS push button configuration You can easily set up a wireless connection with one push of the WPS button. • This configuration does not work if the security method of your wireless router (access point) is WEP. In this case, use other connection method. ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER 10 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “NEXT” and 1 2 device. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the TV screen. 12 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Hold down INFO (WPS) on the front panel for 3 seconds. “Press WPS button on Access Point” appears on the front display. press ENTER. 11 Tap “Allow” in the message appeared on the iOS Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. 3 Push the WPS button on the wireless router (access point). When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the front display. If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another connection method. About WPS WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance, which allows easy establishment of a wireless home network. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 61 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z ■ C: Using other connection methods If your wireless router (access point) does not support WPS push button configuration method, follow the procedure below to configure the wireless network settings. 1 2 Cursor keys ENTER Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). 3 4 Press ON SCREEN. 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. 7 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to select the desired connection method and select “NEXT”. Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. • Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. ON SCREEN 8 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. The following connection methods are available. WPS Button You can set up a wireless connection with the WPS button while viewing the TV screen. Follow the instructions displayed on the TV screen. Share Wi-Fi Settings (iOS) See “Sharing the iOS device setting” (p.60). Access Point Scan You can set up a wireless connection by searching for an access point. For details on settings, see “Searching for an access point” (p.63). Manual Setting You can setup a wireless connection by entering the required information (such as SSID) manually. For details on settings, see “Setting up the wireless connection manually” (p.63). PIN Code You can set up a wireless connection by entering the unit’s PIN code into the wireless router (access point). The method is available if the wireless router (access point) supports the WPS PIN code method. For details on settings, see “Using the PIN code” (p.64). Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Connection” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless (Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”. • The checkmark indicates the current setting. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 62 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ❑ Searching for an access point ❑ Setting up the wireless connection manually If you select “Access Point Scan” as the connection method, the unit starts searching for access points. After a while, the list of available access points appears on the TV screen. If you select “Manual Setting” as the connection method, the wireless connection setting screen appears on the TV. 1 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired access point and select “NEXT”. You need to setup the SSID (network name), encryption method and security key for your network. 1 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the SSID of the access point and select “NEXT”. 2 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the security method of the access point and select “NEXT”. The wireless connection setting screen appears on the TV. 2 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key and select “NEXT”. ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and press ENTER to start the connection process. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the TV screen. If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another connection method. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Settings None, WEP, WPA-PSK (TKIP), WPA-PSK (AES), WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 63 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 3 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key and select “NEXT”. If you select “None” in Step 2, this setting is not available. Proceed to Step 4. ❑ Using the PIN code If you select “PIN Code” as the connection method, the list of available access points appears on the TV screen. 1 If you select “WEP”, enter either 5 or 13 character string, or 10 or 26 hexadecimal digits. If you select other method, enter either 8 to 63 character string, or 64 hexadecimal digits. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired access point and select “NEXT”. The PIN code of the unit appears on the TV screen. 2 Enter the unit’s PIN code into the wireless router (access point). For details on settings, refer to the instruction manual of the wireless router (access point). 3 ON SCREEN Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and press ENTER to start the connection process. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the TV screen. Cursor keys ENTER 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and press ENTER to start the connection process. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the TV screen. If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another connection method. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. If “Not connected” appears, check that all the information is entered correctly, and repeat from Step 1. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 64 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RECEIVER z Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct) 7 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless Direct” and select “OK”. Follow the procedure below to connect a mobile device to the unit directly. • Wireless Direct connection may be insecure since the communication is not strongly encrypted. The unit may operate by playback operation on wireless devices connected to the unit without permission. 1 2 ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). • Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. 3 4 Press ON SCREEN. 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. • The checkmark indicates the current setting. 8 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the desired security method and select “NEXT”. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Connection” and press ENTER. Settings None, WEP • If you select “None”, the connection may be insecure since the communication is not encrypted. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 65 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 9 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key and select “NEXT”. If you select “None” in Step 8, this setting is not available. Proceed to Step 10. Otherwise, enter either 5 or 13 character string. 11 Configure the Wi-Fi settings of a mobile device. For details on settings of your mobile device, refer to the instruction manual of the mobile device. a Enable the Wi-Fi function on the mobile device. b Select the SSID displayed in Step 10 from the list of available access points. c When you are prompted for a password, enter the security key displayed in Step 10. 12 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER 10 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “OK” and press ENTER to save the setting. The settings made appear on the TV screen. The SSID and security key information is required for setup of a mobile device. PREPARATIONS ➤ Connecting to a network device wirelessly En 66 PLAYBACK Input selection keys Basic playback procedure 1 Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or BD/DVD player) connected to the unit. 2 Use the input selection keys to select an input source. 3 Start playback on the external device or select a radio station. HDMI OUT MUTE VOLUME ON SCREEN Selecting an HDMI output jack 1 Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack. Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be used for signal output changes. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 HDMIOUTSel. OUT1+2 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. Cursor keys ENTER • Listening to FM/AM radio (p.76) • Playing back iPod music (p.83) • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.86) • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.89) Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. OUT 1 Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack. OUT 2 Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks. • You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.68). • Playing back music with AirPlay (p.95) • When “OUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest resolution supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, the unit outputs 720p video signals.) Press VOLUME to adjust the volume. • If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2 or Zone4 (p.138), you can turn on/off each zone by pressing HDMI OUT repeatedly. • Listening to Internet radio (p.92) 4 OUT 1+2 • To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute. • To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE/BALANCE on the front panel (p.108). On-screen input selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select the desired input source and press ENTER. PLAYBACK ➤ Basic playback procedure En 67 Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings with just one touch. You can use up to 12 scenes to register your favorite settings and switch them depending on a playback source. 1 SCENE Press SCENE. The input source and settings registered to the corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on automatically when it is in standby mode. By default, the following settings are registered for each scene. SCENE (SCENE key) ON SCREEN 1 (BD/DVD) 2 (TV) 3 (NET) 4 (RADIO) Input (p.67) AV 1 AUDIO 1 NET RADIO TUNER Audio Select (p.110) Auto Auto — — HDMI Output (p.67) OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 Sound Program (p.70) Sci-Fi STRAIGHT 9ch Stereo 9ch Stereo Pure Direct Mode (p.130) Auto Auto Auto Auto Enhancer (p.75) Off On On On Enhancer Hi-Res Mode (p.109) On On On On Input Cursor keys ENTER HDMI Output Mode • You can select SCENE 1–4 by pressing SCENE on the remote control. Additionally, you can create 8 scenes (SCENE 5–12) and select those scenes from the “Scene” menu (p.114). On-screen scene selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a desired scene and press ENTER. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) En 68 SOURCE Configuring scene assignments 1 Set the unit to the condition (such as input source and sound program) that you want to assign to a scene. 2 Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. Input selection keys SCENE DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 3 SCENE1 SETComplete MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR If you want to control the corresponding playback device after selecting the scene, hold down the corresponding SCENE key and input selection key together for more than 3 seconds. Selecting setting items to be included as scene assignments In addition to the default scene assignments (Input, HDMI Output and Mode), you can also include the following setting items as the scene assignments in “Detail” (p.115) in the “Scene” menu. Sound Tone Control, YPAO Volume, Adaptive DRC, Extra Bass Surround CINEMA DSP 3D Mode, Dialogue Lift, Dialogue Level, Subwoofer Trim, Extended Surround Video Video Mode, Video Adjustment Volume Master Volume Lipsync Lipsync, Delay Speaker Setup Setting Pattern, PEQ Select Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. • If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device yet, see “Registering the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.149) to register it. • The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external device connected to the unit via HDMI. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.115) in the “Scene” menu. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) En 69 Selecting the sound mode The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with your favorite sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo playback). ❑ Selecting a sound program suitable for movies • Press MOVIE repeatedly. On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround decoder and press ENTER. This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for viewing video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games (p.71). PROGRAM ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER ❑ Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo playback • You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing PROGRAM. • You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in the “Sound Program” menu (p.116). • Press MUSIC repeatedly. • The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source. This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for listening music sources or stereo playback (p.72). • You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.13) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in the “Information” menu (p.142). ❑ Selecting a surround decoder MOVIE MUSIC SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT • Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly. This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed multichannel playback from 2-channel sources (p.74). ❑ Switching to the straight decode mode • Press STRAIGHT. This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed sounds in original channels (p.74). ❑ Switching to the Pure Direct mode • Press PURE DIRECT. This mode lets you enjoy pure high fidelity sound by reducing the electrical noise from other circuitry (p.75). ❑ Enabling Compressed Music Enhancer • Press ENHANCER. This mode lets you enjoy compressed music with additional depth and breadth (p.75). PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 70 Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD3/CINEMA DSP 3D) ■ Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE) The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games. ❑ MOVIE THEATER * CINEMA DSP HD³: RX-A3040, CINEMA DSP 3D: RX-A2040 The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP technology (CINEMA DSP HD³/CINEMA DSP 3D). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie theaters or concert halls in your room and enjoy natural stereoscopic sound fields. Sound program category MUSIC DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 CLASSICAL HallinVienna Standard This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio, such as Dolby Digital and DTS. Its design is based on the concept of the ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right, and rear. Spectacle This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie productions. It delivers an expansive sound space to match the cinemascope wide-screen, and boasts a broad dynamic range, providing everything from small delicate sounds to powerful loud booms. Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialogue, sound effects, and background music. Adventure This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but puts emphasis on reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides, powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth creates a clear and powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation of the sounds and the separation of the channels. Drama This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects and background music are reproduced with a gentle echo that does not impinge on the articulation of the dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for long periods. Mono Movie This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies, in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a pleasant space with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate reverberation to the original audio. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Sound program “CINEMA DSP !” (RX-A3040) or “CINEMA DSP n” (RX-A2040) lights up • To use the conventional CINEMA DSP, set “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to “Off”. • The unit creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce 3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected. However, we recommend using front presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of the sound fields (and rear presence speakers for further spatial sounds). • When Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. • (RX-A3040 only) The unit creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce natural 3-dimensional sound fields when front presence speakers are connected but no rear presence speakers. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 71 ❑ ENTERTAINMENT Sports This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts and light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’ voices are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the stadium is realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of the fans in a suitable space. Action Game This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field. Roleplaying Game This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a clearer and more spatial sound field. Music Video This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as if you were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere thanks to the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence sound field that emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall. Recital/Opera This program controls the amount of reverberations at an optimum level and emphasizes the depth and clarity of human voices to offer the reverberations of an orchestra box in front the listener at the same time as providing the acoustic positioning and feeling of presence on the stage. The surround sound field is relatively moderate, but the data for concert hall effects are used to represent the inherent beauty of music. The listener will not be fatigued even after long hours of opera entertainment. ■ Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback (MUSIC) The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources. You can also select stereo playback. ❑ CLASSICAL Hall in Munich This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500 seats that uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the arena. Hall in Vienna This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reverberations from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound. Hall in Amsterdam The large, shoe box shaped hall seats about 2,200 around the circle stage. Reflections are rich and pleasing while the sound travels freely. Church in Freiburg Located in the south of Germany, this grand, stone-built church has a pointed tower at 120 meters in height. Its long and narrow shape and the high ceiling enable the elongated reverberation time and limited initial reflection time. Thus, the rich reverberation rather than the sound itself reproduces the atmosphere of the church. Church in Royaumont This program features the sound field created by the refectory (dining hall) of a beautiful medieval Gothic monastery located in Royaumont on the outskirts of Paris. Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 72 ❑ LIVE/CLUB Village Vanguard The Jazz club is on 7th Avenue, New York. This small club with the low ceiling makes the powerful reflections converge toward the stage located in the center. Warehouse Loft The warehouse resembles some lofts in Soho. Sound reflects off the concrete walls clearly with a lot of energy. Cellar Club This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds that make you feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small stage. The Roxy Theatre This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert venue in Los Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall. The Bottom Line This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound. ❑ STEREO 2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and output from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP). 9ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties. ■ Enjoying sound field effects without surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP) If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 9ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, the unit utilizes Yamaha’s original virtual surround technology to reproduce up to 7-channel surround sound and enable you to enjoy the well-oriented sound field only with the front-side speakers. We recommend using presence speakers in order to enjoy more effective stereoscopic sound field. • When Virtual CINEMA DSP is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. ■ Enjoying surround sound with 5 speakers placed in front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT) If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place them in the rear of your room, you can place them in the front (p.21) and enjoy multi-channel surround sound using Virtual CINEMA FRONT. When “Layout (Surround)” (p.126) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, the unit creates the virtual surround speakers in the rear side to allow you to enjoy multi-channel surround sound with the 5 speakers placed in the front. • When Virtual CINEMA FRONT is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. ■ Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) • CINEMA DSP HD³/CINEMA DSP 3D (p.71) and Virtual CINEMA DSP (p.73) do not work when “2ch Stereo” or “9ch Stereo” is selected. You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel speaker system, with stereo headphones by connecting the headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program or a surround decoder. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 73 Enjoying unprocessed playback You can play back input sources without any sound field effect processing. ■ Playing back in original channels (straight decode) When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces stereo sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as CDs, and produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for multichannel sources. 1 The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel playback from 2-channel sources. When a multichannel source is input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode. For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.162). 1 Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder. Each time you press the key, the surround decoder changes. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP Press STRAIGHT. HD 3 Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is enabled or disabled. STRAIGHT VOLUME L C R SL SW1 SR SBL SBR SUR.DECODE ProLogic bPro Logic bPLIIx Movie bPLII Movie bPLIIx Music SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT ■ Playing back 2-channel sources in multichannel (surround decoder) bPLII Music MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for all sources. Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for movies. Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for music. • To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to a setting other than “Off”. bPLIIx Game Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro Logic II decoder) suitable for games. • If “Layout (Surround)” (p.126) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, Virtual CINEMA FRONT (p.73) works when multi-channel source is played back. bPLII Game Neo:6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for movies. Neo:6 Music Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for music. • You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are connected or when “Surround Back” (p.125) in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 74 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry in order to reduce the electrical noise from other circuitry (such as the front display). It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality. 1 Press PURE DIRECT. Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is enabled or disabled. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP PUREDIRECT HD 3 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available. – Some settings for the speakers or sound programs – Operating the on-screen menu and some items in the “Option” menu – Using the multi-zone function – Output from the AV OUT jacks – Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation) PURE DIRECT Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the sound, allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original sound before it was compressed. This function can be used along with any other sound modes. In addition, Compressed Music Enhancer enhances the quality of uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel PCM and FLAC) when “Hi-Res Mode” (p.109) in the “Option” menu is set to “On” (default). 1 Press ENHANCER. Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer is enabled or disabled. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP EnhancerOn HD 3 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR “ENHANCER” lights up ENHANCER • Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on signals whose sampling rate is over 48 kHz. • You can also use “Enhancer” (p.109) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer. PLAYBACK ➤ Selecting the sound mode En 75 Listening to FM/AM radio You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting from registered radio stations. TUNER • The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used in U.K. and Europe models. • If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM antennas. Selecting a frequency for reception 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. 2 Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM). DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP Setting the frequency steps FM87.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR HD 3 (Asia and General models only) At the factory, the frequency step setting is set to 50 kHz for FM and 9 kHz for AM. Depending on your country or region, set the frequency steps to 100 kHz for FM and 10 kHz for AM. BAND TUNING 1 2 Set the unit to standby mode. When holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT 3 Use the following keys to set a frequency. TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for about a second to search stations automatically. Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT). DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 FM98.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. Numeric keys “STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received. PROGRAM 3 Press PROGRAM repeatedly to select “TUNER FRQ STEP”. DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 4 5 TUNERFRQSTEP FM50/AM9 Press STRAIGHT to select “FM100/AM10”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. • “Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range. • (U.S.A. model only) You can switch between “Auto” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception in “Audio Mode” (p.111) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it. (HD Radio programs are not available when the unit is in the monaural reception mode.) • (Except for U.S.A. model) You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.111) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 76 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their preset numbers. TUNER • You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals and HD Radio stations (U.S.A. model only) by using “Auto Preset” (p.80, p.82). Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number. 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. 2 Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio station. You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. ■ Registering a radio station Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number. 1 ■ Selecting a preset station Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.76) to tune into the desired radio station. Preset DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 01:FM98.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • “No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered. • (U.S.A. model only) To register a specific HD Radio program, select an audio program (p.78) after tuning into the radio station. PRESET Numeric keys MEMORY 2 Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds. • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. • To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.80, p.82). The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter, each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty (unused) preset number after the most recently registered number. Preset number DOCK TAG HD Preset PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 STEREOSLEEP TUNED HD 3 01:FM98.50MHz PresetOK MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into the desired radio station, use PRESET or numeric keys to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again. “Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered Preset DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 02:Empty FM98.50MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 77 HD Radio™ tuning ■ Selecting an HD Radio™ audio program (U.S.A. model only) You can select an audio program when the unit is tuned into an HD Radio station that provides multiple audio programs (up to 8). HD Radio Technology is a new technology that enables FM/AM radio stations to broadcast programs digitally. Digital broadcasting provides listeners with radically improved audio quality and reception as well as new data services. Furthermore, supplemental program services allow listeners to select from up to 8 HD Radio programs multicast on a single FM HD Radio channel. For further information on HD Radio Technology, visit “http://www.ibiquity.com/”. The unit is equipped with an HD Radio reception feature, facilitating CD quality FM broadcasts as well as analog FM stereo quality AM broadcasts. In addition, the unit can receive both audio and data (such as song titles, artist names, album titles and program types) from all HD Radio programs (HD1 to HD8). 1 Press MODE repeatedly to select a desired audio program. You can also enter an audio program number (1 to 8) directly by using the numeric keys. For example, to select program 3, press 3 and then ENT (or just leave it). DOCK TAG HD2/3 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP TUNED HD 3 FM88.9MHz3 WXYZ-FM MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR ■ Displaying the HD Radio™ information You can switch the HD Radio information displayed on the front display. 1 MODE Program Service Data: Contributes to the superior user experience Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the item switches. of HD RadioTechnology. Presents song name, artist, station IDs, HD2/HD3 Channel Guide, and other relevant data streams. TUNING Adjacent to traditional main stations are extra local FM channels. These HD2/HD3 Channels provide new, original music as well as deep cuts into traditional genre. INFO DOCK TAG IN OUT 1 OUT 2 HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP TUNED HD 3 Digital, CD-quality sound. HD Radio Technology enables local radio Info Category stations to broadcast a clean digital signal. AM sounds like today’s FM and FM sounds like a CD. Numeric keys ENT MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Item name About 3 seconds later, the information is displayed. When tuning into an HD Radio station HD1/3 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP TUNED HD HD 3 FM88.9MHz1 WXYZ-FM “HD” lights up FM88.9-1 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 Relative/total program number (when multiple programs are available) DOCK TAG DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP TUNED HD 3 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Absolute program number (when multiple programs are available) WXYZ-FM RhythmandBlu MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Station Info Frequency, station name (call sign) Category Station name (call sign), program category Artist/Song Station name (call sign), artist name/song title Album Station name (call sign), album title DSP Program Frequency, sound program selected on the unit Audio Decoder Frequency, decoder selected on the unit • The unit is capable of receiving both hybrid and all-digital FM/AM radio stations. If you cannot search the desired all-digital HD Radio station by holding down TUNING, enter the frequency directly using the numeric keys. • When the unit is in the monaural reception mode (p.111), you can tune into the analog part of a hybrid HD Radio station only. • Some audio programs may not provide information depending on the station or period of time. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 78 ■ HD Radio™ operation on the TV TUNER Menu Submenu Function You can view the HD Radio information or select a radio station on the TV. FM 1 Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency. Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically. Program (+/-) Selects an audio program (when multiple audio programs are available). Memory Registers the selected station as presets. Direct Enters a frequency directly. Switches to FM/AM. AM Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. The playback screen is displayed on the TV. Manual Tuning ❑ Playback screen 3 1 2 4 Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 1 Radio station information Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (FM/AM) and frequency. When tuning into an HD Radio station, the selected audio program number and HD Radio information (station name [call sign], program category, artist name, album name and song title) are also displayed. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. 2 HD indicator Lights up when an HD Radio station signal is received. 3 TUNED/STEREO indicators “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. 4 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 79 ■ Browse screen Radio Data System tuning (U.K. and Europe models only) 1 3 2 Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM stations in many countries. The unit can receive various types of Radio Data System data, such as “Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station. ■ Displaying the Radio Data System information 1 Preset station list Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. 1 Tune into the desired Radio Data System broadcasting station. 2 Preset number • We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System broadcasting stations (p.82). 3 Operation menu Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Function Memory Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. Auto Preset Automatically registers HD Radio (FM/AM) stations and FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. INFO Utility 2 Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 Info ProgramType MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Item name About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the displayed item appears. Frequency (always displayed) 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • If HD Radio stations are detected by “Auto Preset”, only the audio program 1 (HD1) will be registered. If you want to register a specific HD Radio program, register it manually (p.77). DOCK TAG HD PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 FM98.50MHz CLASSICS MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Information Program Service Program service name Program Type Current program type Radio Text Information on the current program Clock Time Current time DSP Program Sound mode name Audio Decoder Decoder name PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 80 Operating the radio on the TV • “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System service. TUNER ■ Receiving traffic information automatically When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, the unit automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function, follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station. OPTION Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 1 When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program” (TrafficProgram) and press ENTER. The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds. Press ENTER again to start the search immediately. You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV. • (U.S.A. model only) See “HD Radio™ operation on the TV” (p.79) to operate the radio on the TV. 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. The playback screen is displayed on the TV. ■ Playback screen 3 1 2 4 • To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor keys (q/w) while “READY” is displayed. • To cancel the search, press RETURN. • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the search finishes. DOCK TAG HD Finished PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP STEREO TUNED HD 3 TrafficProgram TPFM101.30MHz MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Traffic information station (frequency) 1 Radio station information Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (FM/AM) and frequency. (U.K. and Europe models only) When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.80), the Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed. 2 Band icon (Except for U.K. and Europe models) Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM. • “TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information stations are found. 3 TUNED/STEREO indicators “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. 4 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 81 Menu Manual Tuning Submenu Function FM AM (U.K. and Europe models only) Switches to FM/AM. Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency. Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically. Memory Registers the selected station as presets. Direct Enters a frequency directly. Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. ■ Browse screen 1 3 2 1 Preset station list Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. 2 Preset number 3 Operation menu Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Function Memory Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. Auto Preset Automatically registers FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. Utility 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • (U.K. and Europe models only) Only Radio Data System broadcasting stations are stored automatically by “Auto Preset”. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to FM/AM radio En 82 Playing back iPod music You can play back iPod music on the unit using a USB cable supplied with the iPod. Playback of iPod content Follow the procedure below to operate the iPod contents and start playback. USB • For details on playable iPod devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.165). You can control the iPod with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 Connecting an iPod Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. Connect your iPod to the unit with the USB cable supplied with the iPod. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 1 2 Connect the USB cable to the iPod. Connect the USB cable to the USB jack. The unit (front) • If playback is ongoing on your iPod, the playback screen is displayed. 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 USB Connected MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR • The iPod charges while it is connected to the unit. If you set the unit to standby mode while the iPod is charging, the iPod continues to charge up to 4 hours. If “Network Standby” (p.134) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, it continues to charge without limit. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • Disconnect the iPod from the USB jack when it is not in use. • To operate the iPod manually to select content or control playback, switch to the simple play mode (p.85). PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 83 ■ Browse screen ■ Playback screen 1 2 3 1 2 3 5 4 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.85) and playback status (such as play/pause). 3 Contents list External device operation keys Displays the list of iPod content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.85) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 Playback information 2 List name Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 1 Status indicators Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. 3 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Function 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. Play Control 10 Pages Down Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. f g Return Returns to the higher-level list. h Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. j Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Skips forward/backward. Searches forward/backward (by holding down). Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to control playback. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 84 ■ Operating the iPod itself or remote control (simple play) 1 You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings of your iPod. Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode. The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are enabled. 2 ■ Shuffle/repeat settings • During simple play, configure the shuffle/repeat settings directly on your iPod or press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below. To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again. 1 When “USB” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. Operate your iPod itself or the remote control to start playback. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. Operational remote control Function keys OPTION Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys MODE Cursor keys Select an item. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. ENTER Confirms the selection. • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. a External device operation keys d Starts playback or stops playback temporarily. s Stops playback. f g h j Skips forward/backward. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Item Shuffle (Shuffle) Searches forward/backward (by holding down). Repeat (Repeat) 4 Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. Songs (Songs) Plays back songs in random order. “x” appears in the TV screen. Albums (Albums) Plays back albums in random order. “x” appears in the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears in the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs repeatedly. “v” appears in the TV screen. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back iPod music En 85 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on the unit. USB The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or FAT32 format). • If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display. • Stop playback of the USB storage device before disconnect it from the USB jack. • The audio may be interrupted while using the wireless network connection. In this case, use the wired network connection. • For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.165). Connecting a USB storage device 1 Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack. The unit (front) IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 USB Connected Playback of USB storage device contents Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device contents and start playback. You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. USB storage device DOCK TAG HD • Connect a USB memory device directly to the USB jack of the unit. Do not use extension cables. • If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is displayed. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 86 2 ■ Browse screen Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. 1 2 3 If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. 5 4 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 List name 3 Contents list Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. • If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 87 ■ Playback screen ■ Shuffle/repeat settings You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of USB storage device contents. 1 2 3 1 When “USB” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. 1 Status indicators • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as play/pause). • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. 2 Playback information OPTION Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys 3 Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. Item 3 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Play Control Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. Shuffle (Shuffle) Repeat (Repeat) f g Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Skips forward/backward. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 4 Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 88 Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit. • To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router (p.43). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. • The audio may be interrupted while using the wireless network connection. In this case, use the wired network connection. • For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.165). ❑ For Windows Media Player 11 1 2 3 Start Windows Media Player 11 on your PC. 4 Click “OK” to exit. Select “Library”, then “Media Sharing”. Check the “Share my media to” box, select the unit’s icon, and click “Allow”. Media sharing setup To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each music server. ■ For a PC with Windows Media Player installed ❑ For Windows Media Player 12 1 2 3 4 Start Windows Media Player 12 on your PC. 5 Click “OK” to exit. • For details on media sharing settings, refer to Windows Media Player help. ■ For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server software installed Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and configure the media sharing settings. Select “Stream”, then “Turn on media streaming”. Click “Turn on media streaming”. Select “Allowed” from the drop-down list next to the unit’s model name. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 89 Playback of PC music contents Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and start playback. NET You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the input source. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. • If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. ■ Browse screen 1 2 3 The browse screen is displayed on the TV. 5 4 Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 1 Status indicators Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.91) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 List name • If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the playback screen is displayed. 3 Contents list 2 Use the cursor keys to select a music server and press ENTER. 4 Item number/total 3 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. 5 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 90 ■ Playback screen ■ Shuffle/repeat settings You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for the playback of PC music content. 1 2 3 1 When “SERVER” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. 1 Status indicators • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.91) and playback status (such as play/pause). 2 Playback information OPTION Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Play Control 3 Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. Shuffle (Shuffle) Repeat (Repeat) f g Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Item 3 Operation menu Menu • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. Skips forward/backward. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 4 Setting Function Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. • You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.113). PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 91 Listening to Internet radio You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world. NET • To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.43). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. Playback of Internet radio 1 Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. • You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations. • The unit uses the vTuner Internet radio station database service. • This service may be discontinued without notice. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to Internet radio En 92 ■ Browse screen ■ Playback screen 1 2 3 1 2 3 5 4 1 Playback indicator 1 Playback indicator 2 List name 2 Playback information Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. 3 Contents list Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys 4 Item number/total 5 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function Bookmark On (Bookmark Off) Adds/removes the station selected in the list to/from the “Bookmarks” folder (p.94). 3 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. Menu Submenu Adds the current station to the “Bookmarks” folder (p.94). Bookmark On Play Control Function s Stops playback. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. • You can also use the external device operation key (s) on the remote control to stop playback. • Some information may not be available depending on the station. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to Internet radio En 93 Registering favorite Internet radio stations (bookmarks) By registering your favorite Internet radio stations to “Bookmarks”, you can quickly access to them from the “Bookmarks” folder in the browse screen. 3 ■ Registering the station on the browse/playback screen 1 Select the desired Internet radio station in the browse screen or start playback of it to display the playback screen. 2 Press the cursor key (r) to select “Bookmark On” and press ENTER. Access the vTuner website (http://yradio.vtuner.com/) with the web browser on your PC and enter the vTuner ID. You can switch the language. The selected station is added to the “Bookmarks” folder. Cursor keys ENTER Enter the vTuner ID in this area. • To remove stations from the “Bookmarks” folder, select the station in the “Bookmarks” folder and then “Bookmark Off”. ■ Registering the station on the vTuner website 1 Select any of Internet radio stations on the unit. This operation is necessary to register the radio station for the first time. 2 Check the vTuner ID of the unit. • To use this feature, you need to create your personal account. Create your account using your e-mail address. 4 Register your favorite radio stations. Click the “Add” icon (❤+) next to the station name. • To remove the station from the “Bookmarks” folder, select “Bookmarks” in the Home screen, and then click the “Remove” icon (❤–) next to the station name. You can find the vTuner ID (MAC address of the unit) in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. PLAYBACK ➤ Listening to Internet radio En 94 Playing back music with AirPlay The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on the unit via network. iTunes Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music contents on the unit. PC 1 Router The unit Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or display the playback screen on the iPod. If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon ( iTunes (example) (wired or wireless) ) appears. iPod (example) iPhone/iPad/ iPod touch • If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are connected to the router properly. • To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same router. You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. 2 • When using a multiple SSID router, access to the unit might be restricted depending on the SSID to connect. Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit. On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and select the unit (network name of the unit) as the audio output device. iTunes (example) iPod (example) • For details on supported iPod devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.165). Network name of the unit 3 Select a song and start playback. The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and starts playback. The playback screen is displayed on the TV. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music with AirPlay En 95 Menu • You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by setting “Network Standby” (p.134) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. • You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on iTunes/iPod in “Network Name” (p.135) in the “Setup” menu. Play Control • If you select the other input source on the unit during playback, playback on the iTunes/iPod stops automatically. • You can adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod during playback. To disable volume controls from iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.113) in the “Input” menu to “Off”. Submenu Function a Resumes playback from pause. d Stops playback temporarily. f g Skips forward/backward. Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Screen Off Caution • When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, stop playback on the iTunes/iPod immediately. Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN External device operation keys • You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. • To control iTunes playback with the remote control of the unit, you need to configure the iTunes preferences to enable iTunes control from remote speakers in advance. ■ Playback screen 1 2 iTunes (example of English version) 3 1 Playback indicator 2 Playback information Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. Check this box 3 Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. To close the submenu, press RETURN. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back music with AirPlay En 96 Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input sources in the room where the unit is installed (main zone) and in other rooms (Zone2, Zone3 and Zone4). ■ Enjoying videos/music in other rooms For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main zone), another person can listen to PC music in the study room (Zone2), and another can listen to radio in the guest room (Zone3) and play DVD in the kitchen (Zone4). ❑ Enjoying videos/music using a TV and speakers You can enjoy videos/music using TVs placed in other rooms. Video (ZONE OUT or HDMI) • Video/audio signals that can be output to each zone vary depending on how you connect the device in each zone to the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone output” (p.167). • Since there are many possible ways to use the unit in a multi-zone configuration, we recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center about the multi-zone connections that best meet your requirements. Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT) Multi-zone configuration examples Guest room (Zone2 or Zone3) ■ Enjoying music in other rooms Living room (main zone) You can enjoy music using speakers placed in other rooms. Connections TV (for analog video playback): p.99 TV (for digital video playback): p.99 Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.32 Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.98 Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT) ❑ Enjoying videos/music using only a TV Study room (Zone2 and/or Zone3) Video/audio (HDMI) Living room (main zone) Connections Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.32 Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.98 Kitchen (Zone2 or Zone4) Living room (main zone) Connection TV: p.99 PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 97 Preparing the multi zone system ❑ Using an external amplifier Connect the device that will be used in other rooms to the unit. Connect the external amplifier placed in Zone2 or Zone3 to the unit with a stereo pin cable and connect speakers to the external amplifier. Caution The unit (rear) • Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting speakers or an external amplifier. • Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on. ZONE OUT (ZONE 2 or ZONE 3) jacks ZONE OUT/PRE OUT L ■ Connecting speakers to play back audio Connect speakers to play back audio in Zone2 or Zone3. The connection method varies depending on the amplifier being used (the unit or an external amplifier). R ZONE 2 / F.PRESENSE ❑ Using the unit’s internal amplifier ZONE 3 / R.PRESENSE External amplifier Audio input (analog stereo) L Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 or Zone3 to the unit with speaker cables. For details, see “Connecting Zone2/3 speakers” (p.32). R AUDIO Zone2 or Zone3 Main zone • (RX-A3040 only) You cannot use an external amplifier for Zone2 when the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks are set to output front presence channel audio in “Power Amp Assign” (p.124) in the “Setup” menu. Also, you cannot use an external amplifier for Zone3 when the ZONE OUT/PRE OUT jacks are configured to output rear presence channel audio. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 98 ■ Connecting a video monitor to play back analog videos Connect a video monitor to watch analog videos at Zone2 or Zone3. Depending on the video input jacks available on your video monitor, choose one of the video connection methods. ■ Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as a TV) to play back videos/audio at Zone2 or Zone4. If you connect an AV amplifier, you can enjoy multi-channel playback in another room (Zone4). • The video conversion between the analog video jacks does not work for multi-zone video output. To watch videos played back on a video device on the zone video monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to the unit in the same way as the video device. For example, if you want to watch videos input from the DVD player via a component video cable, connect the video monitor to the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks with a component video cable. • To watch videos played back on a video device at Zone2 or Zone4, you need to connect the video device to the unit with an HDMI cable (p.38). • On-screen operations are not available for Zone3 when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2”. • On-screen operations are not available for Zone4. The unit (rear) The unit (rear) • We recommend that you disable HDMI Control on the playback devices connected to the unit. HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack (Example: using a TV) HDMI input HDMI OUT HDMI 2 (ZONE OUT) HDMI MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT PB Y PR Video input (component video or composite video) PR COMPONENT VIDEO PB Y HDMI Y PR PB PR PB V Y ZONE OUT jacks (COMPONENT VIDEO or VIDEO) VIDEO Zone2 or Zone4 V (Example: using an AV amplifier) HDMI input HDMI HDMI Zone2 or Zone3 Main zone Main zone To assign the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT jacks to the video monitor for Zone2 or Zone3, set “Monitor Out Assign” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2” or “Zone3”. Zone4 To assign the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack to Zone2 or Zone4, set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2” or “Zone4”. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 99 • When the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2, you can enable/disable the audio output from the HDMI OUT 2 jack by setting “Audio Output” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu to “On” or “Off” (default). • You can also use speakers placed in Zone2 to output audio (p.32). • Videos/audio interruptions may happen in another zone when any of the following operations is performed. ■ Operating the unit from another room (remote connection) You can operate the unit and external devices from Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 using the supplied remote control if you connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE IN/OUT 1 or REMOTE IN/OUT 2 jacks. – Tuning on/off a TV connected to the unit via HDMI or switching the TV input – Enabling/disabling a zone output or selecting its input source – Changing the sound mode or audio settings (such as “Extended Surround”) • To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, you must register a remote control code for each device before using (p.148). REMOTE IN/OUT 1–2 jacks The unit (rear) REMOTE IN Infrared signal transmitter 1 OUT IN 2 OUT Infrared signal receiver External device (such as a CD player) Remote control Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 Main zone PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 100 Controlling Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 Remote connections between Yamaha products RECEIVER z Input selection keys An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using Yamaha products that support remote connections, as the unit does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal receiver. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE ZONE 1 2 REMOTE IN IN OUT When zone audio output is enabled, the corresponding zone indicator lights up in the front display. 3 Infrared signal receiver Press RECEIVER z. Each time you press the key, the selected zone is enabled or disabled. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks OUT Use the ZONE switch to select a zone. Yamaha products (up to six, including the unit) Use the input selection keys to select an input source. • Video/audio signals that can be output to each zone vary depending on how you connect the device in each zone to the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone output” (p.167). Remote control • You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “SERVER”. Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 4 Start playback on the external device or select a radio station. Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. For details on the following operations, see the corresponding pages. • Listening to FM/AM radio (p.76) • Playing back iPod music (p.83) • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.86) • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.89) • Listening to Internet radio (p.92) • Playing back music with AirPlay (p.95) • You can also use the web control (p.103) to control Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4. • AirPlay is available in Zone2 and Zone3 only when AirPlay playback is ongoing in the main zone. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 101 Caution • To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4. PARTY SCENE ■ Other operations for Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 The party mode allows you to play back in all zones the same music that is being played back in the main zone. During the party mode, stereo playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function when you want to use main zone music as background music for a house party. The following functions are also available when the zone you want to operate is enabled. 1 Press VOLUME or MUTE. Selecting the input source and settings at once (SCENE) MUTE When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the front display. Press SCENE. • To register the current settings (input source, volume and tone control) to a scene, hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. (Only an input source can be registered for Zone4.) • You can select the zones to be included in the party mode in “Party Mode Set” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu. • Zone4 output is available only when an HDMI input is selected in the main zone. Setting the sleep timer SLEEP Press PARTY. Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or off. Adjusting the volume (for Zone2 and Zone3 only) VOLUME ■ Enjoying the same source in multiple rooms (party mode) Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off). Adjusting the high-/low-frequency range of sounds (for Zone2 and Zone3 only) a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel to select the zone to be operated. b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”. c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. Setting range -10.0 dB to +10.0 dB (2.0 dB increments) Default 0.0 dB Adjusting the front speaker balance (for Zone2 and Zone3 only) a Press ZONE CONTROL on the front panel to select the zone to be operated. b Press TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Balance”. c Press PROGRAM to make an adjustment. PLAYBACK ➤ Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 102 Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) You can control the unit with the web control screen displayed in a web browser. Web browser • You can check the IP address of the unit in “Network” (p.143) in the “Information” menu. • You can bookmark the unit’s IP address in the browser or create a shortcut link (p.105) to access the web control screen quickly in the future. However, if you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of the unit may change each time the unit is turned on. Web control • If you have enabled the MAC address filter (p.135), you need to specify the MAC address of your PC to allow the PC to access the unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to its instruction manual. Web control • If you are using Windows 8, we recommend you start Internet Explorer in the following way. PC Router The unit – Select “Desktop” in the Start screen and click the Internet Explorer icon at the bottom left of the screen. • By using the application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER”, you can control the unit from an iPhone, iPad, iPod touch or Android devices. Visit the Yamaha website for details. • To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router. • Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of the unit to your PC. In these cases, configure the security software appropriately. • To display the web control screen or turn on the unit from the web control when the unit is in standby mode, set “Network Standby” (p.105) to “On”. • We recommend using one of the following web browsers. – Internet Explorer 9.x, 10.x or 11.x – Safari 6.x 1 2 Start the web browser. Enter the IP address of the unit in the address bar of the web browser. (Example) PLAYBACK ➤ Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) En 103 ■ Top menu screen ■ Control screen 3 1 5 1 6 2 3 4 5 7 1 CONTROL Moves to the control screen for the selected zone. 2 STATUS Turns on/off the power for each zone or displays the input source and volume set for each zone. 3 SETTINGS Moves to the settings screen. 4 PARTY MODE Turns on/off the party mode (p.102). 5 SYSTEM POWER Turns on/off the power for all zones. 6 MAIN VOLUME Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can also select the increments used for volume adjustment. 4 2 6 1 PLAY INFO Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone. 2 TOP MENU Moves to the top menu screen. 3 SCENE Selects a scene for the selected zone. 4 POWER Turns on/off the power for the selected zone. 5 VOLUME Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You can also select the increments used for volume adjustment. 6 RELOAD Reloads the current status of the unit. 7 RELOAD Reloads the current status of the unit. • Multi-zone volume adjustment is not available when an external amplifier is used. • Multi-zone volume adjustment on the web control may not work on the unit depending on the unit’s settings. PLAYBACK ➤ Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) En 104 ■ Settings screen Note • If the network settings are changed, you may need to restart the browser or regain access to the unit. • When using the MAC address filter, make sure you specify the MAC addresses of your network devices correctly. Otherwise, the unit will be inaccessible from your network devices such as PCs and other external devices. 1 • Do not operate the unit during the recovery process, as this may result in the incorrect recovery of the settings. When the recovery finishes, click “OK” to set the unit to standby mode. • The backup does not contain user information (such as user account and password) or unit-specific information (such as MAC address and IP address). • Some characters entered with a PC may not appear correctly on the unit. 2 3 1 Rename Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.135) or the name of each zone (p.136). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. Network Selects the network connection method (p.134) or configures the network parameters (such as IP address) (p.134). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. MAC Filter Sets the MAC address filter (p.135) to limit access to the unit from the network devices. Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. Auto Reload Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On” (enabled), the web control screen reloads the status of the unit every 5 seconds. Network Standby Enables/disables the network standby function (p.134). Backup/Recovery Creates a backup of the unit’s settings on the PC or restores the settings from the backup. Firmware Update Updates the firmware of the unit by using the firmware you have downloaded on the PC. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the firmware update. Create Link Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen. Tips Displays tips for use of the web control. 2 BACK Moves to the top menu screen. 3 RELOAD Reloads the current status of the unit. PLAYBACK ➤ Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) En 105 Viewing the current status Switching information on the front display 1 Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 Info AudioDecoder Input source group USB SERVER AirPlay MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR NET RADIO Item Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) * During simple playback of iPod: DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) Song (song title), Album (album name), Station (station name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) Item name About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the displayed item appears. DOCK TAG HD DISPLAY PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 AV1 ProLogic * The name of the audio decoder currently activated is displayed. If no audio decoder is activated, “Decoder Off” appears. Viewing the status information on the TV MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Information 1 Press DISPLAY. The following information is displayed on the TV. Compressed Music Enhancer/Hi-Res mode status INFO • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed item can also be applied separately to each input source group. Input source group Item AV 1–7 V-AUX AUDIO 1–4 PHONO DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) TUNER * (U.S.A. model only) HD Radio data is also available when the unit is tuned into an HD Radio station (p.78). * (U.K. and Europe models only) Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.80). Input source/ Party mode status Volume/ YPAO Volume status Audio format/ Decoder Sound mode CINEMA DSP status 2 To close the information display, press DISPLAY. PLAYBACK ➤ Viewing the current status En 106 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This menu is available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily configure settings during playback. 1 Press OPTION. Option menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. DOCK TAG HD IN OUT 1 OUT 2 PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 2 3 4 SLEEP HD 3 Option ToneControl • Default settings are underlined. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Front display Item Function Tone Control (Tone Control) Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of sounds. 108 YPAO Volume (YPAO Vol.) Enables/disables YPAO Volume. 108 Adaptive DRC (A.DRC) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume is adjusted. 108 Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. 109 Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. 109 Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. 109 Enables/disables Extra Bass. 109 Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 109 Hi-Res Mode (HiRes Mode) Enables/disables the high-resolution mode (for enhancing the quality of uncompressed digital audio). 109 Enables/disables the video signal processing settings configured in the “Setup” menu. 110 Selects a video adjustment setting from presets. 110 Input Trim (In.Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. 110 Audio Select (A.Sel) Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input source. 110 Video Out (V.Out) Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 110 YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume) Dialogue (Dialog) TV screen 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. To exit from the menu, press OPTION. Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim) Subwoofer/Bass (Subwoofer/Bass) Extra Bass (Extra Bass) Enhancer (Enhancer) Video Mode Video Processing (V.M) (Video Process.) Video Adjustment (Video Adjust) Input Settings (Input Settings) Page PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 107 Item Function Audio Mode (Audio Mode) (U.S.A. model only) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM/AM radio reception. Page 111 FM Mode (FM Mode) (Except for U.S.A. model) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. 111 Traffic Program (TrafficProgram) (U.K. and Europe models only) Automatically searches for a traffic information station. 81 Shuffle (Shuffle) Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.85), USB storage device (p.88), or media server (p.91). — Repeat (Repeat) Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.85), USB storage device (p.88), or media server (p.91). — ■ YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume) Enables/disables YPAO Volume or Adaptive DRC. YPAO Volume (YPAO Vol.) Enables/disables YPAO Volume. When YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural sounds even at low volume. Settings Off (Off) Disables YPAO Volume. On (On) Enables YPAO Volume. • YPAO Volume works effectively after the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have been already saved (p.47). • We recommend enabling both YPAO Volume and Adaptive DRC when you are listening at lower volumes or at night. ■ Tone Control (Tone Control) Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds. Choices Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass) Adaptive DRC (A.DRC) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to playback at a low volume at night. Setting range -6.0 dB to Bypass (Bypass) to +6.0 dB, 0.5 dB increments Settings Off (Off) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted. On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range when YPAO Volume is enabled. • If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels. • You can also adjust the “Tone Control” setting with the front panel controls by pressing TONE/BALANCE repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”, and PROGRAM to make an adjustment. If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a high volume. On Off Input level Volume: high Output level Output level Volume: low On Off Input level PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 108 ■ Dialogue (Dialog) Extra Bass (Extra Bass) Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds. Enables/disables Extra Bass. When Extra Bass is enabled, you can enjoy enhanced bass sounds, regardless of the size of the front speakers and the presence or absence of the subwoofer. Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you can turn up its volume by increasing this setting. Setting range 0 to 3 Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is coming from below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this setting. Settings Off (Off) Disables Extra Bass. On (On) Enables Extra Bass. ■ Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer and the high-resolution mode. Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.75). • This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met. – One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 9ch Stereo) is selected when front presence speakers are used. • This setting is applied separately to each input source. – Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.71) is working. (You may hear dialogue sounds from the surround speakers depending on the listening position.) • You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.75). Setting range 0 to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position) Settings Ideal position Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer. On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer. Default TUNER, USB, (network sources): On (On) Others: Off (Off) • Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on signals whose sampling rate is over 48 kHz. ■ Subwoofer/Bass (Subwoofer/Bass) Adjust the subwoofer volume or bass sound. Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim) Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. Setting range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) Hi-Res Mode (HiRes Mode) Enables/disables the high-resolution mode when “Enhancer” is set to “On”. If this function is set to “On”, you can enhance the quality of uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel PCM and FLAC) using Compressed Music Enhancer. Settings On (On) Enables the high-resolution mode. (The high-resolution mode may not work depending on the audio signal processing condition.) Off (Off) Disables the high-resolution mode. PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 109 ■ Video Processing (Video Process.) Audio Select (A.Sel) Configures the video signal processing settings. Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input source. Video Mode (V.M) Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution, aspect ratio and video adjustments) settings configured in “Processing” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu. Settings Direct (Direct) Disables the video signal processing. Processing (Processing) Enables the video signal processing. Video Adjustment (Video Adjust) Selects a video adjustment setting from presets you have configured in “Adjustment” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu. Settings Auto (Auto) Automatically selects the audio input jack in the following priority order. 1. HDMI input 2. Digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL) 3. Analog input (AUDIO) HDMI (HDMI) Always selects HDMI input. No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the HDMI jack. Coax/Opt (Coax/Opt) Always selects digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the COAXIAL or OPTICAL jack. Analog (Analog) Always selects analog input (AUDIO). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the AUDIO jacks. Video Out (V.Out) • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. Settings 1 to 6 Settings ■ Input Settings (Input Settings) Configures the input settings. Off (Off) Does not output video. AV 1–7 (AV1–7), V-AUX (V-AUX) Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks. Default USB: V-AUX (V-AUX) Others: Off (Off) • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Input Trim (In.Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it. Setting range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 110 ■ Audio Mode (Audio Mode) (U.S.A. model only) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM/AM radio reception. • This setting is applied separately to each band (FM/AM). Settings Auto (Auto) Receives the selected band (FM or AM) in stereo sounds when the signal reception is good and in monaural sounds when it is not good. Mono (Mono) Receives the selected band (FM or AM) in monaural sounds. • HD Radio programs are not available when the unit is in the monaural reception mode. ■ FM Mode (FM Mode) (Except for U.S.A. model) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. Settings Stereo (Stereo) Receives FM radio in stereo sounds. Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds. PLAYBACK ➤ Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 111 CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the input source settings using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Input menu items • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. • Default settings are underlined. The input source of the unit also changes. • You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. Item Function Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 113 Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 113 Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. 113 DMC Control Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. 113 CONFIGURATIONS Page ➤ Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 112 ■ Rename/Icon Select ■ Decoder Mode Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”. Input sources AV 1–7, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–4, PHONO, USB, MULTI CH ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a template and press the cursor key (w). For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS”. Input sources AV 1–7, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–4 (available only when any audio digital input jack is assigned) Settings Auto Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal. DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.) ■ Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. Input sources AirPlay Settings 2 3 4 • You cannot change the template or icon for “USB” when an iPod is connected. Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). Limited Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range (-80 dB to 0 dB and mute). Full Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to +16.5 dB and mute). Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. ■ DMC Control Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. Input source SERVER Settings Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback. Enable Allows DMCs to control playback. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 5 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network. When this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media Player 12) on the same network. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 113 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.68) using the TV screen. 1 2 3 Press ON SCREEN. 5 6 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Scene menu items Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Item Function Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. Page 114 Load Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can also configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. 115 Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 115 Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 116 ■ Save Registers the unit’s current settings (such as input source and sound program) in the selected scene. • If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.69). 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 114 ■ Load Choices Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. Input Input (p.67), Audio Select (p.110) Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene assignments. HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.67) Mode Sound Program (p.70), Pure Direct Mode (p.130), Enhancer (p.75), Enhancer Hi-Res Mode (p.109) Sound Tone Control (p.108), YPAO Volume (p.108), Adaptive DRC (p.108), Extra Bass (p.109) Surround CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (p.130), Dialogue Lift (p.109), Dialogue Level (p.109), Subwoofer Trim (p.109), Extended Surround (p.130) Video Video Mode (p.131), Video Adjustment (p.110) Volume Master Volume (p.67) Lipsync Lipsync (p.129), Delay (p.129) Speaker Setup Setting Pattern (p.124), PEQ Select (p.127) Device Control Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to the unit via HDMI. (SCENE link playback) Settings Off Disables the SCENE link playback function. HDMI Control Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if an HDMI Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is connected to the unit via HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports HDMI Control. Default Input, HDMI Output, Mode: selected Sound, Surround, Video, Volume, Lipsync, Speaker Setup: not selected Default SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control SCENE3 (NET), SCENE4 (RADIO), SCENE5–12: Off ■ Rename/Icon Select • To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.168). Detail Selects items to be included as the scene assignments. You can also view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). 2 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. To include items as the scene assignments, use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to check the box (or uncheck the box to exclude). For example, if you often adjust the volume while watching TV but listen to radio with low volume at night, exclude “Volume” from the assignments for SCENE2 (TV) and include “Volume” in the assignments for SCENE4 (RADIO). Check or uncheck CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 115 3 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Reset Restores the default settings (p.68) for the selected scene. • You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 116 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. Sound Program menu items • Available items and the default settings vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder. • Default settings are underlined. ■ Settings for sound programs Item • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. • To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”. 5 6 Function Settings Decode Type Selects a surround decoder to be used in combination with the selected sound program. bPro Logic*, bPLIIx Movie (bPLII Movie), bPLIIx Music* (bPLII Music*), bPLIIx Game* (bPLII Game*), Neo:6 Cinema, Neo:6 Music* (* Available only when “SURROUND DECODER” is selected) DSP Level -6 dB to 0 dB to +3 dB Adjusts the sound field effect level. Higher to enhance the sound field effect, and lower to reduce it. Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and presence sound field generation. Surround Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround sound field generation. Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Surround Back Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround back sound field generation. Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the presence sound field. Surround Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround sound field. Surround Back Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround back sound field. Liveness Adjusts the loss of the presence sound field. Surround Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround sound field. Surround Back Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround back sound field. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ 1 ms to 99 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. 1 ms to 49 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. 0.1 to 2.0 Higher to enhance the broadening effect, and lower to reduce it. 0 to 10 Higher to enhance the reflectivity, and lower to reduce it. Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 117 The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “9ch Stereo”. Item Function Settings Reverb Time Adjust the decay time of the rear reverberant sound. 1.0 s to 5.0 s Higher to enrich the reverberant sound and lower to have clear sound. Reverb Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and reverberant sound generation. 0 ms to 250 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. Adjusts the volume of the reverberant sound. 0% to 100% Higher to strengthen the reverberant sound, and lower to weaken it. Reverb Level Sound program 2ch Stereo Item Function Settings Direct Selects whether to automatically bypass the DSP circuit when an analog audio source is played back. Auto, Off Level Adjusts the entire volume. -5 to 0 to +5 Front / Rear Balance Adjusts the front and rear volume balance. -5 to 0 to +5 Higher to enhance the front side, and lower to enhance the rear side. Left / Right Balance Adjusts the left and right volume balance. -5 to 0 to +5 Higher to enhance the right side, and lower to enhance the left side. Height Balance Adjust the height volume balance using the presence speakers. 0 to 5 to 10 Higher to enhance the upside, and lower to enhance the downside. (The presence speakers do not produce sounds when “Height Balance” is set to “0”.) Monaural Mix Enables/disables monaural sound output. Off, On 9ch Stereo • Available items in “9ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 118 ■ Settings for decoders The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “SURROUND DECODER” to “bPLIIx Music” (bPLII Music) or “Neo:6 Music”. Decode Type bPLIIx Music (bPLII Music) Neo:6 Music Item Function Settings Panorama Adjusts the broadening effect of the front sound field. Off, On Select “On” to wrap front left/right channel sounds around the field and generate a spacious sound field in combination with the surround sound field. Center Width Adjusts the broadening effect of the center sound field. 0 to 3 to 7 Higher to enhance the broadening effect, and lower to reduce it (closer to center). Dimension Adjusts the difference in level between the front and surround sound fields. -3 to 0 to +3 Higher to strengthen the front sound field and lower to strengthen the surround sound field. Center Image Adjusts the center orientation level (broadening effect) of the front sound field. 0.0 to 0.3 to 1.0 Higher to strengthen the center orientation level (less broadening effect) and lower to weaken (more broadening effect). CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 119 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 5 6 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 120 Setup menu items Menu Item Function Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). 47 Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. 124 Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. 124 Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 124 Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 125 Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 125 Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 125 Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 125 Auto Setup Speaker Configuration Manual Setup Lipsync Sound Page Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size. 126 Rear Presence Selects whether or not rear presence speakers are connected and their size. 126 Subwoofer 1 Subwoofer 2 Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected to the SUBWOOFER 1 or SUBWOOFER 2 jack and its phase. 126 Layout Selects the layouts of the surround speakers, front/rear presence speakers and subwoofers. 126 Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 127 Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 127 Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 127 Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 128 Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 129 Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 129 Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 129 Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 129 Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. 129 Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 130 Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode. 130 Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level. 130 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 130 Extended Surround Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used. 130 VPS (RX-A3040 only) Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers. 130 CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 121 Menu Video HDMI Network Item Function Page Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution, aspect ratio and video adjustments). 131 HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 132 Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 133 Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 133 Network Connection Selects the network connection method. 134 IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 134 Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 134 MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 135 Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 135 Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 136 Network Name Main Zone Set Zone2 Set Zone3 Set Zone Rename Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 or Zone3 output. 136 Max Volume Sets the Zone2 or Zone3 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness in the second zone. 136 Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 or Zone3 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 136 Mono Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 or Zone3 output. 137 Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone2 or Zone3) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 137 Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2 or Zone3) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 137 Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone4) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 137 Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone4) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 137 Monitor Out Assign Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT jacks are used. 137 HDMI OUT2 Assign Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used. 138 Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode for each zone. 138 Input Assignment Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. 138 Multi Zone Zone4 Set Display Set Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 139 Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 139 Wallpaper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 139 Trigger Output1 Trigger Mode Trigger Output2 Target Zone Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 139 Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 140 DC OUT Selects how to supply power through the DC OUT jack. 140 Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 140 Function Memory Guard Power Mode CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 122 Menu Item Function Page Auto Power Standby Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 141 ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 141 Select an on-screen menu language. 142 ECO Language CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 123 Speaker (Manual Setup) Configures the speaker settings manually. ■ Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. Choices Pattern1 > 2 Copies the “Pattern1” parameters to “Pattern2”. Pattern2 > 1 Copies the “Pattern2” parameters to “Pattern1”. • Default settings are underlined. ■ Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. The unit has 9 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 11 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system. Settings ■ Setting Pattern Basic Select this option when you use the basic speaker configuration (up to 9-channel plus rear presence speakers) (p.19). 7ch +1ZONE Select this when you use 7-channel speakers in the main zone and Zone2 (or Zone3) speakers (p.30). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 1 jacks (default: Zone2). 9ch +1ZONE Select this when you use 9-channel speakers in the main zone and Zone3 (or Zone2) speakers (p.30). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 2 jacks (default: Zone3). 7ch +2ZONE Select this when you use 7-channel speakers in the main zone, plus Zone2 and Zone3 speakers (p.31). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 1 jacks (default: Zone2) and EXTRA SP 2 jacks (default: Zone3). 9ch +RP (RX-A3040 only) Select this when you use 9-channel speakers plus rear presence channel expansion using an external amplifier (p.27). • The setting pattern currently selected is shown at the top of the “Manual Setup” screen. 9ch +FRONT • This function is useful when you want to save certain settings according to the varying conditions of your listening environment. For example, if you want to switch the settings when curtains are open or closed, you can save the settings suited for each condition and switch between them. (RX-A3040 only) Select this when you use 9-channel speakers plus front channel expansion using an external amplifier (p.28). 7ch +FP+RP (RX-A3040 only) Select this when you use 7-channel speakers, plus front presence and rear presence channel expansion using an external amplifier (p.28). Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. When you configure the following speaker settings, the settings will be memorized in the selected pattern. • Measurement results (Auto Setup) • Power Amp Assign • Configuration • Distance • Level • Parametric EQ Settings Pattern1, Pattern2 CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 124 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE Select this when you use 7-channel speakers plus front channel expansion using an external amplifier in the main zone and Zone3 (or Zone2) speakers (p.29). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 2 jacks (default: Zone3). Select this when you use 5-channel speakers plus front channel expansion using an external amplifier in the main zone, plus Zone2 and Zone3 speakers (p.29). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 1 jacks (default: Zone2) and EXTRA SP 2 jacks (default: Zone3). 7ch BI-AMP Select this when you use 7-channel speakers (including bi-amp front speakers) (p.26). 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE Select this when you use 7-channel speakers (including bi-amp front speakers) in the main zone and Zone3 (or Zone2) speakers (p.26). You can select a zone to be assigned to the EXTRA SP 2 jacks (default: Zone3). (RX-A3040 only) 7ch BI-AMP +FP+RP Select this when you use 7-channel speakers (including bi-amp front speakers), plus front presence and rear presence channel expansion using an external amplifier (p.27). ■ Configuration Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. Settings Large Select this option for large speakers. The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency components. Small Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). None Select this option when no center speaker is connected. The front speakers will produce center channel audio. Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes. Settings Large Select this option for large speakers. The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel frequency components. Small Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). None Select this option when no surround speakers are connected. The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program. Configures the output characteristics of the speakers. • When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm (6-1/4”) or larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”). Front Selects the size of the front speakers. Settings Surround Back Large Select this option for large speakers. The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components. Small Select this option for small speakers. The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). • “Front” is automatically set to “Large” when both “Subwoofer 1” and “Subwoofer 2” are set to “None”. Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes. Settings Large x1 Select this option when one large speaker is connected. The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Large x2 Select this option when two large speakers are connected. The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 125 Small x1 Select this option when one small speaker is connected. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Small x2 Select this option when two small speakers are connected. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). None Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected. The surround speakers will produce surround back channel audio. Subwoofer 1, Subwoofer 2 Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected to the SUBWOOFER 1 or SUBWOOFER 2 jack and its phase. Settings Normal Select this option when a subwoofer is connected to the SUBWOOFER 1 or SUBWOOFER 2 jack (phase not reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Reverse Select this option when a subwoofer is connected to the SUBWOOFER 1 or SUBWOOFER 2 jack (phase reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Use • This setting is not available when “Surround” is set to “None”, or when “Layout (Surround)” is set to “Front”. Front Presence None Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size. Select this option when no subwoofer is connected to the SUBWOOFER 1 or SUBWOOFER 2 jack. The front speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels when both “Subwoofer 1” and “Subwoofer 2” are set to “None”. Settings Large Select this option for large speakers. Small Select this option for small speakers. None Select this option when no front presence speakers are connected. • When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase. Layout Rear Presence Selects the layouts of the surround speakers, front/rear presence speakers and subwoofers. Selects whether or not rear presence speakers are connected and their size. Surround Settings Selects a surround speaker layout when surround speakers are used. Large Select this option for large speakers. Small Select this option for small speakers. None Select this option when no rear presence speakers are connected. Settings Rear Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the rear side of the room. Front Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the front side of the room. Virtual CINEMA FRONT (p.73) works in this case. • This setting is not available when “Surround” or “Front Presence” is set to “None”. • This setting is not available when “Configuration (Surround)” is set to “None”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 126 Front Presence Selects a front presence layout when front presence speakers are used. This setting facilitates the optimization of the sound field effect. Settings Front Height Select this option when front presence speakers are installed on the front side wall. Overhead Select this option when front presence speakers are installed to the ceiling. ■ Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance from “Meter” or “Feet”. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Rear Presence L, Rear Presence R, Subwoofer 1, Subwoofer 2 Setting range 0.30 m to 3.00 m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 10.0 ft to 80.0 ft), 0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments • This setting is not available when “Configuration (Front Presence)” is set to “None”. Rear Presence Selects a rear presence layout when rear presence speakers are used. This setting facilitates the optimization of the sound field effect. Settings Rear Height Select this option when rear presence speakers are installed on the rear side wall. Overhead Select this option when rear presence speakers are installed to the ceiling. ■ Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Rear Presence L, Rear Presence R, Subwoofer 1, Subwoofer 2 Setting range -10.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) ■ Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. • This setting is not available when “Configuration (Surround/Front Presence/Rear Presence)” is set to “None”. Subwoofer Settings Manual Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually. For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”. YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics. YPAO:Front Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as the front speakers. YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound. Through Does not use the equalizer. Selects a subwoofer layout when 2 subwoofers are used. Settings Left + Right Select this option when 2 subwoofers are placed on the left and right sides of the room. Front + Rear Select this option when 2 subwoofers are placed on the front and rear sides of the room. Monaural x2 Select this option when 2 subwoofers are placed freely. • “YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have already been saved (p.47). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results. • This setting is not available when “Subwoofer 1” or “Subwoofer 2” is set to “None”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 127 ■ Manual equalizer adjustment 1 2 3 Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER. Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen. Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER. • To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”. ■ Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker balance or equalizer while confirming its effect. Settings Off Does not output test tones. On Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance or equalizer. • To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.47) to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type. 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the 7 preset bands (4 for subwoofer) and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Setting range Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB 5 To fine-adjust the center frequency or Q factor (bandwidth), press ENTER repeatedly to select an item. Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Setting range Center frequency: 31.3 Hz to 16.0 kHz (31.3 Hz to 250.0 Hz for subwoofer) Q factor: 0.500 to 10.080 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 128 Sound Adjustment Configures the audio output settings. Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”. ■ Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio by holding up the audio output. Setting range 0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments) Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. Choices AV 1–7, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–4 Settings Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. Enable Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. Auto/Manual Select • When “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”, “Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment. ■ Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. Settings Maximum Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range. Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use. Minimum/Auto Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low volumes. When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is automatically adjusted based on the input signal information. Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. Setting range Auto Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the unit via HDMI. If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. Manual Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video and audio output manually. Adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. ■ Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB • Even if “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”, the automatic adjustment does not work depending on the TV connected to the unit. In this case, adjust the delay manually in “Adjustment”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 129 ■ Initial Volume ■ Extended Surround Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on. Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers are used. Settings Off Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80.0 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (Specify a volume level which is lower than the “Max Volume” setting.) ■ Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode (p.75). Settings Auto Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if signals that contain surround back channel signals are input, and reproduces the signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. If two surround back speakers are connected, the unit reproduces the 5.1-channel signals in 7.1-channel. bPLIIx Movie Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround back speakers are connected. bPLIIx Music Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two surround back speakers are connected. EX/ES Automatically selects the Dolby EX or DTS-ES decoder, and reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. Off Always reproduces signals in their original channels. (Even when DTS-ES or Dolby Digital Surround EX signal is input, the unit reproduces the signal in 5.1-channel.) Settings Auto Video Off Automatically outputs video signals when any videos are input from the selected input source or an input source that can be operated with the on-screen display is selected. When no video signals are input, the wall paper is displayed. Does not output video signals including the wall paper. ■ Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level. • Some early Dolby Digital Surround EX or DTS-ES sources do not contain a flag for reproducing surround back channel. We recommend you set “Extended Surround” to “bPLIIx Movie” or “EX/ES” when playing back those sources. Settings Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically. On Adjusts the effect level automatically according to the YPAO measurement results and the volume level. ■ CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Enables/disables CINEMA DSP HD³ (RX-A3040) or CINEMA DSP 3D (RX-A2040) (p.71). If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP HD³/CINEMA DSP 3D functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 9ch Stereo). Settings Off Disables CINEMA DSP HD³/CINEMA DSP 3D. On Enables CINEMA DSP HD³/CINEMA DSP 3D. ■ VPS (RX-A3040 only) Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers. When VPS is enabled, the unit creates front VPS when no front presence speakers are connected, and creates rear VPS when front presence speakers are connected but no rear presence speakers (p.71). Settings Off Disables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS). On Enables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS). • Depending on the installation height of the surround speakers, VPS may not be effective. In this case, set “VPS” to “Off”. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 130 Video Aspect Configures the video output settings. Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Settings Through Does not convert the aspect ratio. 16:9 Normal Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the screen. • This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or 2160p (4K) signals. ■ Video Mode Adjustment Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution, aspect ratio and video adjustments). Configures the video adjustments when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. You can register the video adjustments as presets (up to 6). Settings ■ Setup procedure Direct Disables the video signal processing. Processing Enables the video signal processing. Configure the settings in “Resolution”, “Aspect” and “Adjustment”. 1 2 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a preset number and press ENTER. 3 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. • When “Video Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to reduce video output delay. Resolution Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Settings Through Does not convert the resolution. Auto Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution. 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p, 4K Output video signals with a selected resolution. (Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.) To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Detail Enhancement Adjusts the enhancement effect of video details. Setting range 0 to 50 • If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MONITOR CHECK” (p.146) in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on your TV normally.) CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 131 Edge Enhancement HDMI Adjusts the enhancement effect of video edges. Setting range 0 to 50 Configures the HDMI settings. Brightness Adjusts the video brightness. Setting range -100 to 0 to +100 Contrast Adjusts the video contrast. Setting range -100 to 0 to +100 Saturation Adjusts the video saturation. ■ HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.168). Settings Setting range -100 to 0 to +100 Off Disables HDMI Control. On Enables HDMI Control. Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”. • To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.168) after connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices. TV Audio Input Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner. Settings AUDIO 1–4 Default AUDIO 1 • When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 132 ARC HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 Enables/disables ARC (p.169) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 jack or HDMI OUT 2 jack. Settings Off Disables ARC. On Enables ARC. • You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected to the unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to “Off” and use the TV’s speakers. Settings Off Disables the audio output from the TV. On Enables the audio output from the TV. • The HDMI OUT 1–2 jacks output 2-channel audio signals when the unit is turned on. Standby Sync ■ Standby Through Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. If this function is set to “On”, you can use the input selection keys (AV 1–7 and V-AUX) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the standby indicator on the unit blinks). Settings Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. Auto Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals. Settings Off Does not output videos/audio to the TV. On Outputs videos/audio to the TV. (The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.) ■ Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. • This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. • The “Amp” and “HDMI OUT1” settings are available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. • The “HDMI OUT2” setting is available only when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) is set to “Main”. Amp Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers and headphones connected to the unit. Settings Off Disables the audio output from the speakers and headphones. On Enables the audio output from the speakers and headphones. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 133 ■ Manual network settings Network Configures the network settings. ■ Network Connection Selects the network connection method. Settings Wired Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network with a commercially-available network cable (p.43) Wireless (Wi-Fi) Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network via the wireless router (access point). For details on settings, see “Connecting the unit to a wireless network” (p.60). Wireless Direct Select this option when you want to connect a mobile device to the unit directly. For details on settings, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct)” (p.65). ■ IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 1 2 Set “DHCP” to “Off”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER. IP Address Specifies an IP address. Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask. Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway. DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server. DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a value. 4 5 6 7 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4. To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Network Standby Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network standby). Settings Off Disables the network standby function. On Enables the network standby function. (The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.) DHCP Select whether to use a DHCP server. Settings Off Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters manually. For details, see “Manual network settings”. On Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network parameters (such as IP address). CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 134 ■ MAC Address Filter ■ Network Name Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. Filter Enables/disables the MAC address filter. Settings Off Disables the MAC address filter. On Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1–10”, specify the MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit. ■ Procedure 1 2 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. • AirPlay (p.95) and DMC (p.113) operations are not subject to the MAC address filter. MAC Address 1–10 Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”. ■ Procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1–5” or “MAC Address 6–10” and press ENTER. 2 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a value. 4 5 6 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 135 Multi Zone Configures the multi zone settings. ■ Zone2 Set, Zone3 Set Configures the Zone2 or Zone3 settings. Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 or Zone3 output. If you have connected an external amplifier with volume control to the unit, disable the volume adjustment for the corresponding zone. Settings Fixed Disables volume adjustments for Zone2 or Zone3 output. Variable Enables volume adjustments for Zone2 or Zone3 output. ■ Main Zone Set Configures the main zone setting. • This setting is not available depending on the “Power Amp Assign” setting (p.124). Zone Rename Max Volume Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. Sets the Zone2 or Zone3 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. ■ Procedure 1 2 Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. • This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”. Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 or Zone3 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. Settings • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Off Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80.0 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (Specify a volume level which is lower than the “Max Volume” setting.) • This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”. Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 136 Mono Zone Rename Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 or Zone3 output. Changes the zone name (for Zone2 or Zone3) displayed on the front display or TV screen. Settings Off Produces stereo sounds in Zone2 or Zone3. On Produces monaural sounds in Zone2 or Zone3. Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone2 or Zone3) displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Procedure 1 2 3 Use the cursor keys to select a scene to be renamed and press ENTER. You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone Set” (p.136). ■ Zone4 Set Configures the Zone4 settings. Zone Scene Rename Changes the scene names (for Zone4) displayed on the front display or TV screen. You can change the scene names in the same manner as “Zone Scene Rename” in “Zone2 Set, Zone3 Set” (p.137). Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. Zone Rename Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. Changes the zone name (for Zone4) displayed on the front display or TV screen. You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone Set” (p.136). ■ Monitor Out Assign Select the zone for which the MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO and VIDEO) jacks are used. Settings Main, Zone2, Zone3 • To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. • To watch videos played back on a video device on the zone video monitor, you need to connect the video monitor to the unit in the same way as the video device. For example, if you want to watch videos input from the DVD player via a component video cable, connect the video monitor to the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks with a component video cable. • To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 137 ■ HDMI OUT2 Assign Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used. Function Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use. Settings Main, Zone2, Zone4 • For details on video/audio signals that can be output to each zone, see “Multi-zone output” (p.167). Audio Output Enables/disables the audio output from the HDMI OUT 2 jack when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” is set to “Zone2”. On Enables the audio output. Off Disables the audio output (video output only). ■ Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.102) for each zone. Choice Target: Zone2, Target: Zone3, Target: Zone4 Settings Disable Disables switching to the party mode. Enable Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control. ■ Input Assignment Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. ■ Procedure Example: assigning the OPTICAL (e) jack to the input source “AV 2” 1 Use the cursor keys to select the cell at the intersection of “AV 2” and “Optical”, and press ENTER. 2 Use the cursor keys to select “e” and press ENTER. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 138 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Trigger Output1, Trigger Output2 Sets the TRIGGER OUT 1–2 jacks to function in sync with the power status of each zone or input switching. • You cannot assign both COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source. Trigger Mode ■ Display Set Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display. Settings Dimmer (Front Display) Power The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the zone specified with “Target Zone”. Source The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in the zone specified with “Target Zone”. An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Source”. Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with “Manual”. Adjusts the brightness of the front display. Setting range -4 to 0 (higher to brighten) • The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.141) is set to “On”. Short Message Source Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as input selection and volume adjustment). Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”. Settings Choices AV 1–7, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–4, PHONO, TUNER, (network sources), USB, MULTI CH On Displays short messages on the TV screen. Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen. Settings Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source specified in this option. High Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in this option. Wallpaper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. Settings Manual Picture 1, Picture 2, Picture 3 Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external device connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack. Choices Low Stops the electronic signal transmission. High Transmits the electronic signal. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 139 Target Zone ■ Memory Guard Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. Prevents accidental changes to the settings. Settings Settings Main When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone. Zone2 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in Zone2. Zone3 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of Zone3. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in Zone3. Zone4 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of Zone4. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in Zone4. All When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of any zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in any zone. Off Does not protect the settings. On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected. • When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen. Icon ■ DC OUT Configures the DC OUT jack setting. Power Mode Selects how to supply power to the Yamaha AV accessory connected to the DC OUT jack. Settings Continuous Supplies power through the DC OUT jack continuously regardless of the power state (on/standby) of the unit. Main Zone Power Sync. Supplies power through the DC OUT jack only when the main zone is turned on. (This setting may not work properly on some accessories.) CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 140 ECO ■ ECO Mode Configures the power supply settings. Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode. When the eco mode is enabled, you can reduce the unit’s power consumption. Settings Off Disables the eco mode. On Enables the eco mode. • The new setting will take effect after the unit is restarted. • When “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark. • If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”. ■ Auto Power Standby Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit or if no input signals are detected for the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby mode. Settings Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically. 20 Minutes Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit and no input signals are detected (or the unit is muted) for 20 minutes. 2 Hours, 4 Hours, 8 Hours, 12 Hours Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for the specified time. For example, when “2 Hours” is selected, the unit will switch to standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours. Default U.K. and Europe models: 20 Minutes Other models: Off • Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerStdby” appears and then countdown starts in the front display. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 141 Language Select an on-screen menu language. Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) You can view information about the unit using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER. Settings English English 日本語 Japanese Français French Deutsch German Español Spanish Russian Italiano Italian Chinese • The information on the front display is provided in English only. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 142 ■ Network Types of information Displays the network information on the unit. ■ Audio Signal (When using wired or wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection) Displays information about the current audio signal. Format Audio format of the input signal Channel The number of source channels in the input signal (front/surround/LFE) For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE). Input IP Address IP address Subnet Mask Subnet mask Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server MAC address Network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.135) Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal MAC Address Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal Network Name The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal Wired/Wireless The status of the wired or wireless connection SSID (When using wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection) The SSID of the wireless network Dialogue Output The speaker terminals from which signals are output (When using Wireless Direct) • Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the specifications and settings of the playback device. ■ Video Signal Displays information about the current video signal. SSID The SSID of the wireless network Security Security method Security Key Security key IP Address IP address Subnet mask HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output Subnet Mask HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI) MAC Address MAC address Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR OUT jacks (analog) Network Connection “Wireless Direct” indication Analog Resolution ■ HDMI Monitor Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”. Interface TV interface Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 143 ■ System Displays the system information on the unit. Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.145) Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.146) Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display. Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.145) Tuner Freq. Step (Asia and General models only) The FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit (p.146) System ID System ID number 1 2 Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit Set the unit to standby mode. While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT • If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.151). PROGRAM ■ Multi Zone Displays information about Zone2, Zone3 and Zone4. Input The input source selected for Zone2, Zone3 or Zone4 Volume The volume for Zone2 or Zone3 3 4 5 Press PROGRAM to select an item. Press STRAIGHT to select a setting. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. The new settings take effect. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 144 ADVANCED SETUP menu items Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) • Default settings are underlined. Item SPIMP.- Function DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP Page HD 3 SPEAKER IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 145 REMOTE SENSOR Turns on/off of the remote control sensor on the main unit. 145 REMOTE CON AMP Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 145 TUNER FRQ STEP (Asia and General models only) Changes the FM/AM tuning frequency setting. 146 TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 146 MONITOR CHECK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 146 RECOV./BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. 147 INITIALIZE Restores the default settings. 147 FIRM UPDATE Updates the firmware. 147 VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 147 SPIMP.HD 3 SPEAKERIMP. 8MIN MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the speakers connected. MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Turn on/off the remote control sensor on the main unit. While the remote control sensor is turned off, you cannot control the unit from the remote control. Settings ON Turns on the remote control sensor. OFF Turns off the remote control sensor. Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE CON AMP) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP REMOTESENSOR ON REMOTECONAMP ID1 MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default: ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver. Settings ID1, ID2 ■ Changing the remote control ID of the remote control 1 To select ID1, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE (BD/DVD) together for 3 seconds. To select ID2, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE (TV) together for 3 seconds. Settings 6 MIN Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 8 MIN Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the unit. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 145 Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TUNER FRQ STEP) (Asia and General models only) DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 SLEEP HD 3 Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP TUNERFRQSTEP FM50/AM9 HD 3 Change the FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit depending on your country or region. Settings FM100/AM10 Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 100-kHz steps and AM by 10-kHz steps. FM50/AM9 Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 50-kHz steps and AM by 9-kHz steps. MONITORCHECK YES MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack. Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution” (p.131) when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a different resolution than the detected resolution. Settings YES Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a resolution supported by the TV only.) SKIP Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.) Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 TVFORMAT NTSC MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC • Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV after “MONITOR CHECK” has been set to “SKIP”. PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV. Settings NTSC, PAL Default U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models: NTSC Other models: PAL CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 146 Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 RECOV./BACKUP BACKUP SPIMP.- MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. ■ Backup/recovery procedure 1 Updating the firmware (FIRM UPDATE) Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “BACKUP” or “RECOVERY” and press INFO to start the process. Choices BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of the unit in the internal memory. RECOVERY Recovers the settings of the unit from the backup (available only when backup has been created). DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 FIRMUPDATE USB MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as needed. Updates can be downloaded from the Yamaha website. If the unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the information supplied with updates. ■ Firmware update procedure Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware. 1 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start firmware update. Choices Note • Do not turn off the unit during the recovery process. Otherwise, the settings may not be restored correctly. USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device. NETWORK Update the firmware via the network. • The backup does not contain user information (such as user accounts and passwords). Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 INITIALIZE CANCEL MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC • If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.151). Checking the firmware version (VERSION) PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Restores the default settings for the unit. Choices SPIMP.- DOCK TAG HD STEREO TUNED PRE AMP PARTY ZONE ZONE ZONE 3 4 IN OUT 1 OUT 2 2 ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations. ALL Restores the default settings for the unit. CANCEL Does not perform an initialization. VERSION x.xx MUTE VOLUME ADAPTIVE DRC PL L C R PR SL SW1 SW SW2 SR PL SBL SB SBR PR Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. • You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.144) in the “Information” menu. • It may take a while until the firmware version is displayed. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 147 SOURCE Controlling external devices with the remote control You can use the unit’s remote control to operate external devices (such as BD/DVD players) if you have registered the remote control code of the external device. 3 4 Press TV z. Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote control code. • You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor. • Ensure that the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly. Once the remote control code is successfully registered, SOURCE blinks twice. • If the unit’s remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the registered codes may be cleared. If this happens, insert new batteries and register the codes again. If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2. ■ TV operations • Under the unit’s default settings, the amplifier code (Yamaha: 5098) is set for all the input selection keys. With this setting, you can control HDMI Control-compatible devices connected to the unit with the remote control. (This function may not work depending on the specification of the external device.) Once you have registered the remote control code for your TV, you can control it using the TV operation keys, regardless of the input source selected on the unit. Registering the remote control code for a TV You can use the unit’s remote control to operate a TV if you have registered its remote control code. TV operation keys INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV. MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV. TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV. TV CH Switch the channels of the TV. TV z Turns on/off the TV. Numeric keys TV operation keys TV z CODE SET • You can also register your TV’s remote control code to the unit’s input selection keys (p.149). This would allow you to use the cursor keys or numeric keys to operate the TV (this function may not be available on some TV models). 1 Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM to find your TV’s remote control code. • If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If that does not work, try the other codes. 2 Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 2. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 148 SOURCE z SOURCE RECEIVER Input selection keys Registering the remote control codes for playback devices You can use the unit’s remote control to operate playback devices if you have registered their remote control codes. You can also use the input selection keys to change the playback devices that are controlled by the remote control, because their remote control codes are assigned to the input selection keys. 1 Once you have registered the remote control code for your playback device, you can control it using the following keys after selecting the input source or scene. • By pressing SOURCE or RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (the unit or external device) that are operated by the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and numeric keys. You can operate the unit after pressing RECEIVER (lights up in orange), and an external device after pressing SOURCE (lights up in green). For example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on TUNER, you can operate the unit’s built-in FM/AM radio after pressing RECEIVER and the external device after pressing SOURCE. SOURCE z Turns on/off the playback device. Cursor keys External device operation keys Menu operation keys Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM to find the remote control code for your playback device. ■ Playback device operations • If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If that does not work, try the other codes. 2 Press CODE SET. Menu operation keys Select an item. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen. Displays the top menu. DISPLAY Switches information on the display. DISPLAY SOURCE blinks twice. TOP MENU External device operation keys Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 2. POP-UP/MENU Displays the pop-up menu. s Stops playback. d Stops playback temporarily. a Starts playback of the selected song/video. Numeric keys 3 TV operation keys CODE SET 4 External device operation keys Press the input selection key. For example, press AV 1 to set the remote control code for the playback device connected to the AV 1 jack. h Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote control code. f Once the remote control code is registered successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. j g Searches forward/backward (by holding down). Skips forward/backward. Numeric keys Enter numerical values. TV operation keys Control the TV (p.148). If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2. • For details on how to register a remote control code to a SCENE key, refer to “Configuring scene assignments” (p.69). CONFIGURATIONS • These keys work only if the corresponding function is available on your playback device and if the device can be operated with an infrared remote control. ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 149 Resetting remote control codes SOURCE RECEIVER Input selection keys You can reset a remote control code registered to each input selection key. 1 Press CODE SET. SOURCE blinks twice. Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens, repeat from Step 1. 2 3 Press the input selection key. Use the numeric keys to enter “5098”. Once the remote control code is reset successfully, SOURCE blinks twice. If it blinks six times, resetting has failed. Repeat from Step 1. To reset the remote control to factory default settings a Press CODE SET. b Press RECEIVER. c Use the numeric keys to enter “9981”. Numeric keys CODE SET CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Controlling external devices with the remote control En 150 Updating the unit’s firmware via the network New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and update it. 3 If “UPDATE SUCCESS PLEASE POWER OFF!” appears on the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front panel. The firmware update is complete. Note • Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more (depending on your Internet connection speed). • If the unit is connected to the wireless network, network update may not be possible depending on the condition of the wireless connection. In this case, update the firmware using the USB memory device (p.147). • If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in Step 2. “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a message will be displayed in the “System” screen (p.144). You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen. • For details on update, visit the Yamaha website. Cursor keys ENTER • You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.147). Information icon A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. Message System Icon 1 2 Read the on-screen description. To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to select “START” and press ENTER. The on-screen display turns off. CONFIGURATIONS ➤ Updating the unit’s firmware via the network En 151 APPENDIX Frequently asked questions The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound balance... If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the speaker settings again (p.47). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.124). Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the volume control... If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for the unit in advance (p.129). You can also set the maximum volume for Zone2 or Zone3 (p.136). I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning on the unit... By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the volume to be applied when the receiver is turned on (p.130). You can also set the initial volume for Zone2 or Zone3 (p.136). We are bothered by volume differences when switching between input sources… enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback devices, refer to the instruction manuals for each device. I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during operations... By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.139) in the “Setup” menu to turn off the short messages. I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings... You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.140). The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another Yamaha product as well as the unit... When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another Yamaha product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens, register different remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each remote control (p.145). You can correct volume differences between input sources by utilizing “Input Trim” in the “Option” menu (p.110). I want to enjoy videos/audio played back on the video device even when the unit is in standby mode... I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at all... If you have connected a video device to the unit with HDMI, you can output videos/audio played back on the video device to the TV even when the unit is in standby mode. To use this function, set “Standby Through” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. You can also switch the input source using the remote control of the unit when this function is enabled. To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.168). After connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit, APPENDIX ➤ Frequently asked questions En 152 Troubleshooting Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. First, check the following: a The power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets securely. b The unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on. c The connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device. Power, system and remote control Problem Cause Remedy The power does not turn on. The protection circuitry has been activated three times consecutively. When the unit is in this condition, the standby indicator on the unit blinks if you try to turn on the power. As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair. The power does not turn off. The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet and plug it again.) The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.23). The unit enters standby mode automatically. The unit is not reacting. The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again. The auto-standby function kicked in because the unit was not used for the specified time. To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Standby” in the “Setup” menu to “Off” (p.141). The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.145). The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.23). The protection circuitry has been activated because the volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.141). The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power supply voltage. Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet and plug it again.) APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 153 Problem The unit cannot be controlled using the remote control. Cause The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.5). The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries. The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or strong lighting. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit. The remote control is set to control external devices. Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in orange). The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.145). The remote control is set to control the unit. Press SOURCE to set the remote control to control external devices (the key lights up in green). The corresponding remote control code is not set properly. Set the remote control code again (p.148). Even if the remote control code is registered properly, some products may not respond to the remote control. A remote control code for another playback device is assigned to V-AUX. Reset the remote control code registered to V-AUX (p.150). The mobile device or its application is not externally controllable. Directly operate the mobile device itself. External devices cannot be controlled using the remote control. The MHL-compatible mobile device cannot be controlled using the remote control. Remedy APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 154 Audio Problem No sound. Cause Remedy Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input. Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.143). The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.129). The volume cannot be increased. A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit. The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.143). The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the speaker. To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.128). Audio output of the speaker is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.47) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change the speaker settings (p.125). The volume of the speaker is set too low. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.47) or use “Livello” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the speaker volume (p.127). The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable. The speaker is malfunctioning. To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be malfunctioning. The extended surround is disabled. Use “Extended Surround” in the “Setup” menu to select a decoder to be used (p.130). The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency signals. To check if the subwoofer is working properly, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.128). Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.47) or set “Subwoofer 1” or “Subwoofer 2” in the “Setup” menu to “Use” (p.126). The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer. The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level. The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. The unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from the SPEAKERS terminals. In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.133). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. No sound is coming from a specific speaker. No sound is coming from the surround back speaker. No sound is coming from the subwoofer. No sound from the playback device (connected to the unit with HDMI). APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 155 Problem Cause Remedy The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers. Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the speakers connected to the unit. A TV that does not support ARC is connected to the unit only with an HDMI cable. Use a digital optical cable to make an audio connection (p.35). (If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable) The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection. Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack (p.132). (If you are trying to use ARC) ARC is disabled on the unit or TV. Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.133). Also, enable ARC on the TV. No sound from the Zone2 TV (connected to the unit with HDMI). The audio output from the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is disabled. Set “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.138). Only the front speakers work on multichannel audio. The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as PCM) only. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.143). If necessary, change the digital audio output setting on the playback device. No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is used). The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device. The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.141). A device connected to the unit’s output jacks is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks. If the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2 or Zone4, HDMI audio output may be interrupted during some zone operations due to internal circuitry switching. For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio” (p.99). Noise/hum is heard. The sound is distorted. The sound is interrupted. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 156 Video Problem No video. No video from the playback device (connected to the unit with HDMI). Cause Remedy Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MONITOR CHECK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.146). The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit. To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.143). For information about video signals supported by the unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.170). The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. The TV is not connected to the unit via HDMI. You can display the menu of the unit on the TV only when they are connected with an HDMI cable. If necessary, use an HDMI cable to connect them (p.35). The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV. The video is interrupted. Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). (If you are using 2 TVs in the main zone) Another TV is turned off when “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected. Select “HDMI OUT 1” or “HDMI OUT 2” to output the signals only to the TV you are using (p.67). (If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2 or Zone4) HDMI audio output may be interrupted during some zone operations due to internal circuitry switching. For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio” (p.99). APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 157 FM/AM radio Problem Cause There is multi-path interference. Remedy Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. (U.S.A. model only) Set “Audio Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio reception (p.111). FM radio reception is weak or noisy. Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. (Except for U.S.A. model) Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio reception (p.111). Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. AM radio reception is weak or noisy. The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or other electrical equipment. It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor AM antenna. Select the station manually (p.76). Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. Adjust the AM antenna orientation. Radio stations cannot be selected automatically. The AM radio signal is weak. Select the station manually (p.76). Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with the supplied AM antenna. AM radio stations cannot be registered as presets. Auto Preset has been used. Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations and HD Radio station (U.S.A. model only) only. Register AM radio stations manually (p.77). The unit does not receive HD Radio signals. (U.S.A. model only) The unit is in the monaural reception mode. Set “Audio Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Auto” (p.111). APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 158 USB and network Problem Cause Remedy The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again. The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format. Folders and files in the USB device cannot be viewed. The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function. The files in the USB device cannot be played back continuously. Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder. If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the playback folder. The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained properly. Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup” menu to “On” on the unit (p.134). If you want to configure the network parameters manually, check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other network devices in your network (p.134). The unit does not detect the USB device. The wireless router (access point) is turned off. Turn on the wireless router. The unit and the wireless router (access point) are too far apart. Place the unit and the wireless router (access point) closer to each other. There is an obstacle between the unit and the wireless router (access point). Move the unit and the wireless router (access point) in a location where there are no obstacles between them. Microwave ovens or other wireless devices in your neighborhood might disturb the wireless communication. Turn off these devices. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of the wireless router (access point). Check the firewall setting of the wireless router (access point). The media sharing setting is not correct. Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.89). Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access of the unit to your PC. Check the settings of security software installed on your PC. The unit and PC are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and the PC to the same network. The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit. In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the MAC address of your PC to allow it to access to the unit (p.135). The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played back. The files are not supported by the unit or the media server. Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For information about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.89). The files in the PC cannot be played back continuously. Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder. If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the playback folder. The unit cannot connect to the Internet via a wireless router (access point). Wireless network is not found. The unit does not detect the PC. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 159 Problem The Internet radio cannot be played. The iPod does not recognize the unit when using AirPlay. Cause Remedy The selected Internet radio station is currently not available. There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have been stopped. Try the station later or select another station. The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting silence. Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try the station later or select another station. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your network devices (such as the router). Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station. The port number varies depending on the radio station. The unit is connected to a multiple SSID router. Access to the unit might be restricted by the network separation function on the router. Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit. The unit and smartphone/tablet are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and smartphone/tablet to the same network. The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit. In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the MAC address of your smartphone/tablet to allow it to access to the unit (p.135). It may not be possible depending on the condition of the network. Update the firmware via the network again or use a USB memory device (p.147). The application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER” does not detect the unit. Firmware update via the network is failed. APPENDIX ➤ Troubleshooting En 160 Error indications on the front display Message Cause Remedy Access denied Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.89). Access error The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. The unit cannot access the iPod. Turn off the iPod and turn it on again. The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by the unit (p.83). Make sure your router and modem are turned on. There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit. Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.43). Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly. Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. MHL Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the MHL-compatible mobile device. Turn off the unit and check the connection between the unit and mobile device. No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit. The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. The unit cannot detect the iPod. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again. Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network. Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn it on again. RemID Mismatch The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.145). Remote Off The unit cannot be operated from remote control because the remote control sensor on the main unit is turned off. Use the controls on the front panel. To use the remote control, set “REMOTE SENSOR” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “ON” (p.145). The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the USB device for some reasons. Check the song data. If it cannot be played on another device, the song data may be defective. The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some reason. Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be defective. The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some reason. Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.89). If the unit supports the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic. No device Unable to play USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Version error Firmware update is failed. Update the firmware again. APPENDIX ➤ Error indications on the front display En 161 Glossary Audio information ■ Audio decoding format Dolby Digital Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. Dolby Digital EX Dolby Digital EX creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. Dolby Digital Plus Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). Dolby Pro Logic II Dolby Pro Logic II enables 5-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources. Dolby Pro Logic IIx DTS Express DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher compression rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is developed for audio streaming services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS-HD High Resolution Audio DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS-HD Master Audio DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS Neo:6 DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete full-bandwidth matrix channels of surround sound. DSD (Direct Stream Digital) Dolby Pro Logic IIx enables 7-channel playback from 2-channel or multichannel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources and “Game mode” for game sources (for 2-channel sources only). DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super Audio CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz. The highest frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology offers better audio quality than that used for CDs. Dolby TrueHD FLAC Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality. DTS 96/24 DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This format remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for music DVDs, etc. DTS Digital Surround DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. DTS-ES DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a surround back sound is recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a discrete surround back channel is recorded. MP3 One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/10 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. MPEG-4 AAC An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming services on Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality than MP3. PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This technology is the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called Linear PCM for audio on a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs). APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 162 Sampling frequency/Quantization bit Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal is digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”. • Sampling frequency Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate. When the sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider. • Quantization bit The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more accurate. WAV Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other compression methods. WMA (Windows Media Audio) One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. ■ Others Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp) A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification connection, the unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a consequence, the tweeter and woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference. LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio effects. This channel is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio. Lip sync Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an increase in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag between audio and video output. HDMI and video information Component video signal With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. Composite video signal With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined and transmitted with a single cable. Deep Color Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems process the color using 8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology allows HDTVs and other displays to increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. HDMI HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video signal transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable without any loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a secure audio/video interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/”. MHL MHL (Mobile High-definition Link) is the interface standard for high-speed digital video signal transmission that is developed for mobile devices. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals from mobile devices (such as smartphones) using a single cable with any loss. As with HDMI, MHL complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). x.v.Color “x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid, natural images. APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 163 Network information Yamaha technologies SSID CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor) SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a particular wireless LAN access point. Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best experienced in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions (such as room size, wall material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that you hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP, Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own home. Wi-Fi Wi-Fi (Wireless Fidelity) is a technology that allows an electronic device to exchange data or connect to the Internet wirelessly using radio waves. Wi-Fi offers the advantage of eliminating the complexity of making connections with network cables by using wireless connection. Only products that complete Wi-Fi Alliance interoperability tests can carry the “Wi-Fi Certified” trademark. WPS WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance, which allows easy establishment of a wireless home network. CINEMA DSP 3D The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D mode achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and intensive 3D sound fields in a listening room. CINEMA DSP HD³ The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP HD³ feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room. Compressed Music Enhancer The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music formats (such as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound system. SILENT CINEMA Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on headphones. Virtual CINEMA DSP Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front left and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a listening room. Virtual CINEMA FRONT Virtual CINEMA FRONT allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front surround speakers. Even if the surround speakers placed in the front, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a listening room. Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) Virtual Presence Speaker allows the system to virtually reproduce the height of the 3D sound field without presence speakers. Even if the presence speakers are not connected, the unit creates the 3D sound field in your room. APPENDIX ➤ Glossary En 164 Supported devices and file formats ■ Supported devices About HTC Connect This receiver features “HTC Connect”, a simple way to enjoy all music content from your HTC Connect certified smartphone. ❑ USB devices 1. HTC Connect music streaming provided on this product has been developed based on interoperability testing as defined by the HTC Connect program with the HTC Connect compatible smartphones. • This unit supports USB mass storage class devices (e.g., flash memories or portable audio players) using FAT16 or FAT32 format. 2. HTC Connect has been tested with MP3, AAC, WMA and WAV encoding formats. Other formats may not be compatible. • Do not connect devices other than USB mass storage class devices (such as USB chargers or USB hubs), PCs, card readers, an external HDD, etc. 3. High network congestion may interfere with the operation of HTC Connect. • USB devices with encryption cannot be used. • Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer of the USB storage device. ❑ iPod Made for. iPod touch (2nd, 3rd, 4th and 5th generation) iPod nano (2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th, 6th and 7th generation) iPhone 5, iPhone 4S, iPhone 4, iPhone 3GS, iPhone 3G iPad (4th generation), iPad mini, iPad (3rd generation), iPad 2, iPad (as of May 2014) 4. Music navigation via the music progress bar is not currently supported with HTC Connect. Please check HTC website for up to date information about features, compatible devices and audio format support: http://www.htc-connect.com/certified-devices ■ File formats ❑ USB • The unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, FLAC and ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec) files (1- or 2-channel audio only). • The unit is compatible with sampling rate of up to 192 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, 96 kHz for ALAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. • The unit supports gapless playback of WAV, FLAC and ALAC files. • An iPod may not be detected by the unit or some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or software version of the iPod. ❑ AirPlay AirPlay works with iPhone, iPad, and iPod touch with iOS 4.3.3 or later, Mac with OS X Mountain Lion, and Mac and PC with iTunes 10.2.2 or later. (as of May 2014) • Digital Rights Management (DRM) contents cannot be played back. ❑ PC/NAS • The unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, FLAC and ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec) files. • The unit is compatible with sampling rate of up to 192 kHz for WAV and FLAC files, 96 kHz for ALAC files, and 48 kHz for other files. • The unit supports gapless playback of WAV, FLAC and ALAC files. • To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files. • Digital Rights Management (DRM) contents cannot be played back. APPENDIX ➤ Supported devices and file formats En 165 Video signal flow Video signals input from a video device to the unit are output to a TV as shown below. ■ Video conversion table • You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu. • The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably. Video device The unit HDMI out TV Resolution 480i/ 576i 480p/ 576p 720p 1080i 1080p 4K 480i/576i m m m m m m m m m m m 720p m m m m 1080i m m m m 1080p/ 50, 60 Hz m m m m m m 480p/576p HDMI in HDMI out HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI in 1080p/24 Hz COMPONENT VIDEO in COMPONENT VIDEO out COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO m m m m m m m m m m COMPONENT 720p VIDEO in m m m m 1080i m m m m 480i/576i COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR PR PR PB PB PB PB Y Y Y Y m 480p/576p VIDEO 480p/ 576p 720p 1080i 1080p 480i/ 576i m m m m m 1080p VIDEO in VIDEO 480i/ 576i m 4K COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO out COMPONENT VIDEO out VIDEO out VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO in 480i/576i m m m m m m m m: Available APPENDIX ➤ Supported devices and file formats En 166 Multi-zone output ■ Audio output ■ Video output Using the unit's internal amplifier (p.32) Out In Digital audio (HDMI) Digital audio (COAXIAL/OPTICAL) EXTRA SP 1–2 jacks Zone2 Zone3 m (*3) Using an external amplifier (p.98) Out ZONE OUT jacks Zone2 Zone3 m (*3) m (*6) HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack m (*4) m (*6) m (*5) Composite video m m m m m USB (including iPod) m m m m m Network sources m m m m m m m m m COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO Zone2/3 Zone2/3 HDMI video Component video m (*6) Analog audio (AUDIO) TUNER In Zone2 (*1) Zone4 (*2) MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT jacks (*6) On-screen display (browse/playback) HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack (*7) Zone2 Zone4 m m m m m m: Available *6 Available when “Monitor Out Assign” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” or “Zone3” *7 Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” or “Zone4” m m: Available *1 Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” (Audio Output: On) *2 Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone4” *3 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels] when the input source selected in the main zone is selected) Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” *4 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels] when the input source selected in the main zone is selected) *5 HDMI audio pass-through (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels] when the input source selected in the main zone is selected) *6 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input APPENDIX ➤ Supported devices and file formats En 167 (Example) Information on HDMI HDMI Control HDMI Control HDMI Control HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as power and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with an HDMI cable. For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.35) and “Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.38). Turns on and displays video from the playback device Playback starts Press SCENE (BD/DVD) To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after connecting the TV and playback devices. For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. Operations available from the TV’s remote control • Standby synchronization • This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. • Volume control including mute • Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner • Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device • Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker) Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices. Configure the settings of the unit. a Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. b Press ON SCREEN. (Example) HDMI Control HDMI Control Playback device also turns off 1 2 ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER The unit turns off (standby) Turn off the TV c Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Operations available from the unit’s remote control • Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene selection (p.68) • Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed) • Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering remote control codes (p.149) APPENDIX ➤ Information on HDMI En 168 d Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”. Audio Return Channel (ARC) ARC allows you to input TV audio to the unit with the HDMI cable which transmits video signal to the TV. Check the following after the HDMI Control settings. 1 2 e Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. f Use the cursor keys to select “On”. g Press ON SCREEN. 3 Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players). 4 Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and playback devices. 5 6 7 Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV. Select a TV program with the TV remote control. Check that the input source of the unit will be automatically switched to “AUDIO 1” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit. If you cannot hear the TV audio, check the following: – “ARC” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”. – The HDMI cable is connected to the ARC-compatible HDMI jack (HDMI jack marked “ARC”) on the TV. Some HDMI jack on the TV is not compatible with ARC. For details, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. • If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable) to input TV audio to the unit (p.35). • When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. Check the followings. • “AUDIO 1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO 1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.132) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.69), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE (TV). On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. 8 Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 3 and plugging in the TV again in Step 4. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices exceeds the limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use. • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on the TV. • We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works more effectively. • We do not assure the operation of all HDMI Control-compatible devices. APPENDIX ➤ Information on HDMI En 169 HDMI signal compatibility Audio signals Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example) 2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio Multichannel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD DSD 2 to 5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video Bitstream (High definition audio) Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, DTS Express Video signals The unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions: • VGA • 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz • 480i/60 Hz • 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz • 576i/50 Hz • 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz • 480p/60 Hz • 4K/60 Hz, 50Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz • 576p/50 Hz • When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending on the type of the DVD player. • The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the instruction manual for each device. • To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device). For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback device. APPENDIX ➤ Information on HDMI En 170 Reference diagram (rear panel) DC OUT 5V 0.5A HDMI HDMI OUT 2 1 (ZONE OUT) AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 WIRELESS (3 NET ) AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) ARC AC IN PHONO AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (1 BD/DVD) AV OUT MONITOR OUT/ ZONE OUT Y COMPONENT VIDEO PR PB Y AV 2 PB TRIGGER OUT PR B 1 RS-232C REMOTE IN GND 1 OUT 1 IN OUT 2 AUDIO 1 (2 TV) L A Y PB AV 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3 C PR Y AUDIO 4 AV 3 PB PR MULTI CH INPUT 12V 0.1AMAX. TOTAL CENTER ZONE OUT/PRE OUT PRE OUT (SINGLE) (FRONT) R 1 2 1 COAXIAL 2 COAXIAL 3 OPTICAL 4 OPTICAL 5 OPTICAL FRONT 6 COAXIAL SURROUND SUR. BACK ZONE 2/ ZONE 3/ SUBWOOFER F. PRESENCE R. PRESENCE FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK (REAR) SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R ANTENNA 75Ω FM HD Radio AM SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/R.PRESENCE R EXTRA SP2 L CENTER R FRONT L ZONE 2/ZONE 3/F.PRESENCE/ BI–AMP R EXTRA SP1 L (4 RADIO) SINGLE (RX-A3040 U.S.A. model) • The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. APPENDIX ➤ Reference diagram (rear panel) En 171 Trademarks Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic, Surround EX and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Digital Living Network Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited. Windows™ Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS-HD, the Symbol, & DTS-HD and the Symbol together are registered trademarks & DTS-HD Master Audio is a trademark of DTS, Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. This receiver supports network connections. Internet Explorer, Windows Media Audio and Windows Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. Android™ Android is a trademark of Google Inc. HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corporation. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD, HD Radio, and “Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. “Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance. iTunes, AirPlay, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod nano, iPod touch, and Safari are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. HDMI, the HDMI Logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries. The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Logo is a certification mark of the Wi-Fi Alliance. The Wi-Fi Protected Setup Identifier Mark is a mark of the Wi-Fi Alliance. Ubiquitous WPS2.0 Copyright © 2013 Ubiquitous Corp. MHL and the MHL logo are a trademark, registered trademark or service mark of MHL, LLC in the United States and/or other countries. x.v.Color™ “x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation. HTC, HTC Connect and the HTC Connect Logo are either registered trademarks or trademarks of HTC Corporation. “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. APPENDIX ➤ Trademarks En 172 Specifications Input jacks • Analog Audio [RX-A2040] - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz - Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, - 4K/60 Hz, 50Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz SURROUND BACK L/R) Audio x 10 (AV 1–4, AUDIO 1–4, PHONO, V-AUX) - ZONE OUT x 2 (ZONE2/ZONE3) MULTI CH INPUT x 1 (8 ch) • Digital Audio (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, Optical x 1 (AV OUT) SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER) • Video • Digital Audio (Supported frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz) • Audio Format - Dolby TrueHD - Dolby Digital Plus - Dolby Digital - DTS-HD Master Audio Optical x 3 (AV 3–4, AUDIO 1) MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT - DTS-HD High Resolution Audio Coaxial x 3 (AV 1–2, AUDIO 2) - Composite x 1 - DTS Express - Component x 1 - DTS AV OUT - DSD 2-ch to 6-ch - Composite x 1 - PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24-bit) • Video Composite x 5 (AV 1–4, V-AUX) Component x 3 (AV 1–3) • HDMI Output • HDMI Input HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1–2*5) HDMI x 8 (AV 1–7, V-AUX*) *5 barter to ZONE OUT (ZONE2/ZONE4) * V-AUX: MHL input compatible Other jacks • Others USB x 1 (USB2.0) NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX/10Base-T) Output jacks L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, EXTRA SP 1 L/R , EXTRA SP 2 - 480i/60 Hz - 576i/50 Hz - 480p/60 Hz • TRIGGER OUT x 2 - 576p/50 Hz • RS-232C x 1 - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz • DC OUT x 1 *1 Note: Assignment is possible HDMI - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 1080p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz [ZONE2, ZONE3, F.PRESENCE, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)] • HDMI features: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync, ARC *2 Note: Assignment is possible (Audio Return Channel), 3D, 4K Ultra HD [ZONE2, ZONE3, R.PRESENCE] • Video Format (Repeater Mode) - Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1–2, Stereo/Front&Rear/Monox2) - Audio x 1 (AV OUT) [RX-A3040] - Pre Out x 11 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, *3 *4 SURROUND BACK L/R, F.PRESENCE L/R , R.PRESENCE L/R ) *4 Note: barter to ZONE3 • Video Format (Repeater Mode) - VGA L/R*2) *3 Note: barter to ZONE2 MHL • REMOTE IN x 2 - Speaker Out x 11 (9 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND *1 • Link Function: CEC supported • YPAO MIC x 1 • REMOTE OUT x 2 • Analog Audio • Content Protection: HDCP compatible • Audio Format - PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24-bit) • Current Supply Capacity: 1.0 A - VGA TUNER - 480i/60 Hz • Analog Tuner - 576i/50 Hz [U.K. and Europe models] - 480p/60 Hz FM/AM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER) - 576p/50 Hz [Other models] - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz FM/AM x 1 (TUNER) - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz • HD Radio tuner [U.S.A. model] x 1 (TUNER) APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 173 USB Audio Section • Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory • Rated Output Power (2-channel driven) • Current Supply Capacity: 2.1 A [RX-A3040] (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 ) Network Front L/R .......................................................... 150 W+150 W • PC Client Function Center...........................................................................150 W • Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5 Surround L/R ................................................... 150 W+150 W • AirPlay supported • Internet Radio • HTC Connect supported • WiFi function - Capable of WPS by PIN Method and Push-Button-Method - Capable of Direct Connection with Mobile Device - Available Security Method: WEP, WPA-PSK (TKIP), WPA-PSK (AES), WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode - Radio Frequency: 2.4GHz - Wireless Network Standard: IEEE 802.11 b/g Surround Back L/R .......................................... 150 W+150 W Front Presence L/R.......................................... 150 W+150 W (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 ) Front L/R .......................................................... 165 W+165 W Center...........................................................................165 W Surround L/R ................................................... 165 W+165 W Surround Back L/R .......................................... 165 W+165 W Front Presence L/R.......................................... 165 W+165 W [RX-A2040] (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 ) Front L/R .......................................................... 140 W+140 W Center...........................................................................140 W Compatible Decoding Formats Surround L/R ................................................... 140 W+140 W • Decoding Format • Rated Output Power (1-channel driven) [RX-A3040] (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 ) Front L/R.................................................................. 185 W/ch Center ..................................................................... 185 W/ch Surround L/R ........................................................... 185 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................. 185 W/ch Front Presence L/R.................................................. 185 W/ch (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 ) Front L/R [U.K. and Europe models]....................... 230 W/ch [RX-A2040] (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 ) Front L/R.................................................................. 175 W/ch Center ..................................................................... 175 W/ch Surround L/R ........................................................... 175 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................. 175 W/ch Front Presence L/R.................................................. 175 W/ch (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 ) Front L/R [U.K. and Europe models]....................... 220 W/ch • Maximum Effective Output Power (1-channel driven) Surround Back L/R .......................................... 140 W+140 W (JEITA, 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 ) - Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus Front Presence L/R.......................................... 140 W+140 W [China, Korea, Asia and General models] - Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 ) [RX-A3040] - DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, Front L/R .......................................................... 155 W+155 W Front L/R.................................................................. 230 W/ch Center...........................................................................155 W Center ..................................................................... 230 W/ch - DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 Surround L/R ................................................... 155 W+155 W Surround L/R ........................................................... 230 W/ch - DTS Digital Surround Surround Back L/R .......................................... 155 W+155 W Surround Back L/R .................................................. 230 W/ch DTS Express • Post Decoding Format - Dolby Pro Logic - Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie, Dolby Pro Logic II Game - Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game - DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema Front Presence L/R.......................................... 155 W+155 W Front Presence L/R.................................................. 230 W/ch [RX-A2040] Front L/R.................................................................. 220 W/ch Center ..................................................................... 220 W/ch Surround L/R ........................................................... 220 W/ch Surround Back L/R .................................................. 220 W/ch Front Presence L/R.................................................. 220 W/ch • Dynamic Power (IHF) [RX-A3040] Front L/R (8/6/4/2 )................................ 175/220/295/410 W [RX-A2040] Front L/R (8/6/4/2 )................................ 165/210/285/405 W APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 174 • Damping Factor Front L/R, 1 kHz, 8 ............................................. 150 or more • Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance • Tone Control Characteristics Main Zone Bass Boost/Cut......................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB Step) • 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.) Mono ................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf) • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 ) ................................3.5 mV/47 k Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz Mono/Stereo [except U.S.A. model] ..................... 71 dB/70 dB AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 ).......................200 mV/47 k Treble Boost/Cut ..................... ±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB Step) HD [U.S.A. model] ...........................................................80 dB • Maximum Input Signal PHONO (1 kHz, 0.5% THD)............................... 60 mV or more AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) ........................ 2.4 V or more • Output Level / Output Impedance AV OUT ..............................................................200 mV/1.2 k HEADPHONE OUT .............................................150 mV/100 PRE OUT SUBWOOFER (50 Hz) ........................................1.0 V/1.2 k Except SUBWOOFER (1 kHz) ............................1.0 V/1.2 k ZONE OUT.............................................................1.0 V/1.2 k • Frequency Response AUDIO 2 etc. (10 Hz to 100 kHz) ............................... +0/-3 dB • RIAA Equalization Deviation PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz)..........................................0±0.5 dB Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz Zone2/Zone3 Bass Boost/Cut............................. ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB Step) Bass Turnover............................................................. 350 Hz MULTI CH INPUT to Speaker Out (Pure Direct, 70 W, 8 ) .............................................................................0.04% or less • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) (Pure Direct, Input 1 k Shorted, Speaker Out) PHONO...............................................................95 dB or more AUDIO2 etc. ....................................................110 dB or more • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Speaker Out........................................................150 µV or less • Channel Separation (Input 1 k Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) PHONO.................................................... 75 dB/60 dB or more AUDIO2 etc. ........................................... 75 dB/60 dB or more • Volume Control Main Zone.................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step) Zone2/Zone3 ............MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step) Mono/Stereo [except U.S.A. model] ........................0.5%/0.6% HD [U.S.A. model] .......................................................... 0.03% Treble Boost/Cut ........................... ±10 dB/50 Hz (2 dB Step) • Antenna Input................................................ 75 unbalanced Treble Turnover...........................................................3.5 kHz AM section • Filter Characteristics • Tuning Range (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz) [U.S.A. and Canada models]...................530 kHz to 1710 kHz H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back: Small) [Asia and General models] ......530/531 kHz to 1710/1611 kHz ................................................................................. 12 dB/oct. [Other models] .........................................531 kHz to 1611 kHz L.P.F. (Subwoofer)..................................................... 24 dB/oct. Video Section • Video Signal Type General • Power Supply [U.S.A. and Canada models].......................... AC 120 V, 60 Hz [U.S.A., Canada, Korea and General models]................ NTSC [General model] ............ AC 110 to 120/220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz [Other models] ................................................................... PAL [China model] ................................................. AC 220 V, 50 Hz • Video Signal Type (Video Conversion) ..................... NTSC/PAL [Korea model] ................................................. AC 220 V, 60 Hz • Video Signal Level [Australia model]............................................. AC 240 V, 50 Hz • Total Harmonic Distortion PHONO to AV OUT ..............................................0.02% or less • Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz) Composite ............................................................. 1 Vp-p/75 [U.K. and Europe models] .............................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz Component [Asia model].................................... AC 220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz Y ......................................................................... 1 Vp-p/75 • Power Consumption Pb/Pr................................................................ 0.7 Vp-p/75 [Canada model] .............................................................. 400 W • Video Maximum Input Level ...........................1.5 Vp-p or more [Korea model] ................................................................. 390 W • Signal to Noise Ratio .......................................... 60 dB or more • Monitor Out Frequency Response Component (MONITOR OUT/ZONE OUT) ........................................................... 5 Hz to 100 MHz, ±3 dB [Other models] ................................................................ 490 W • Standby Power Consumption HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off .......................... 0.1 W HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals) ..... 2.5 W Network Standby On FM Section Wired ............................................................................. 3.1 W • Tuning Range Wi-Fi .............................................................................. 3.8 W [U.S.A. and Canada models] .............. 87.5 MHz to 107.9 MHz Wireless Direct .............................................................. 3.7 W [Asia and General models] HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals), ...................................... 87.5/87.50 MHz to 108.0/108.00 MHz Network Standby On (Wireless Direct) ............................ 5.7 W [Other models] ................................ 87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 175 • Maximum Power Consumption [Asia and General models]........................................... 1210 W • Dimensions (W x H x D) ...................... 435 x 192 x 467 mm (17-1/8” x 7-1/2” x 18-3/8”) * Including legs and protrusions • Reference Dimensions (W x H x D) (with wireless antenna) ...................... 435 x 252 x 474 mm (17-1/8” x 9-7/8” x 18-5/8”) • Weight [RX-A3040] [China, U.K. and Europe models] ............. 19.6 kg (43.2 lbs) [Other models]........................................... 18.1 kg (39.9 lbs) [RX-A2040] ................................................... 17.0 kg (37.5 lbs) * Specifications are subject to change without notice. APPENDIX ➤ Specifications En 176 Index Symbols Exclamation mark (!) Lock icon (o) 140 144, 151 9ch +RP (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 9ch +RP (speaker configuration) 27 9ch Stereo (sound program) 73 124 Numerics A 16:9 Normal (Aspect, Setup menu) 131 2.1-channel system 21 2ch Stereo (sound program) 73 3.1-channel system 21 4K Ultra HD 170 5.1-channel system 21 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 125 5ch +FRONT+2ZONE (speaker configuration) 29 7.1-channel system 20 7ch +1ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 124 7ch +1ZONE (speaker configuration) 30 7ch +2ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 124 7ch +2ZONE (speaker configuration) 31 7ch +FP+RP (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 124 7ch +FP+RP (speaker configuration) 28 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 125 7ch +FRONT+1ZONE (speaker configuration) 29 7ch BI-AMP (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 125 7ch BI-AMP (speaker configuration) 26 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 125 7ch BI-AMP +1ZONE (speaker configuration) 26 7ch BI-AMP +FP+RP (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 125 7ch BI-AMP +FP+RP (speaker configuration) 27 9.2+2-channel system 19 9.2-channel system 19, 20 9ch +1ZONE (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 124 9ch +1ZONE (speaker configuration) 30 9ch +FRONT (Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) 124 9ch +FRONT (speaker configuration) 28 A.DRC (YPAO Volume, Option menu) 108 A.Sel (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 Access denied (error indication) 161 Access error (error indication) 161 Access Point Scan (Wireless (Wi-Fi), Setup menu) 63 Action Game (sound program) 72 Adaptive DRC (YPAO Volume, Option menu) 108 Adaptive DSP Level (Sound, Setup menu) 130 Adjustment (Lipsync, Setup menu) 129 Adjustment (Video Mode, Setup menu) 131 ADVANCED SETUP menu 144 Advanced speaker configuration 24 Adventure (sound program) 71 AirPlay 95 Album (HD Radio™) 78 AM radio listening 76 Amp (Audio Output, Setup menu) 133 Angle (Horizontal) (YPAO measurement result) 56 Angle/height measurement (YPAO) 50, 54 ARC (Audio Return Channel) 169 ARC (HDMI Control, Setup menu) 133 Artist/Song (HD Radio™) 78 Aspect (Video Mode, Setup menu) 131 Audio Decoder (front display information) 106 Audio file format (PC/NAS) 165 Audio file format (USB storage device) 165 Audio Mode (Option menu) 111 Audio Output (HDMI OUT2 Assign, Setup menu) 138 Audio Output (HDMI, Setup menu) 133 Audio program selection (HD Radio™) 78 Audio Return Channel (ARC) 169 Audio Select (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 Audio Signal (Information menu) 143 Auto Power Standby (ECO, Setup menu) 141 Auto Preset (FM radio) 82 Auto Preset (HD Radio™) 80 Auto Setup (Speaker, Setup menu) 47 Auto/Manual Select (Lipsync, Setup menu) 129 Automatic speaker setting optimization 47 Automatic station preset (FM radio) 82 Automatic station preset (HD Radio™) 80 AutoPowerStdby (ECO, Setup menu) 141 B Backup/recovery of the settings 147 Banana plug 23 Basic playback operation 67 Basic speaker configuration 19 Bass (Tone Control, Option menu) 108 Bitrate (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Bitstream 170 Bookmark Off (Internet radio, Option menu) 94 Bookmark On (Internet radio, Option menu) 94 Brightness (Video Mode, Setup menu) 132 C Category (HD Radio™) 78 Cellar Club (sound program) 73 Center (Speaker, Setup menu) 125 Center Image (Sound Program menu) 119 Center Width (Sound Program menu) 119 Chamber (sound program) 72 Channel (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Check SP Wires (error indication) 161 Check Sur. (YPAO error message) 57 Church in Freiburg (sound program) 72 Church in Royaumont (sound program) 72 CINEMA DSP 8, 71 CINEMA DSP 3D 8, 71 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (Sound, Setup menu) 130 CINEMA DSP HD³ 8, 71 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 177 CLASSICAL (sound program subcategory) 72 Clear Preset (FM/AM radio) 82 Clear Preset (HD Radio™) 80 Clock Time (Radio Data System) 80 Compressed Music Enhancer 75 Configuration (Speaker, Setup menu) 125 Contrast (Video Mode, Setup menu) 132 Crossover frequency setting (subwoofer) 47 D DC OUT (Function, Setup menu) 140 Decode Type (Sound Program menu) 117 Decoder Mode (Input menu) 113 Decoder Off (front display information) 106 Default Gateway (IP Address, Setup menu) 134 Default Gateway (Network, Information menu) 143 Default setting restoration 147 Delay Enable (Lipsync, Setup menu) 129 Detail (Load, Scene menu) 115 Detail Enhancement (Video Mode, Setup menu) 131 Device Control (Load, Scene menu) 115 DHCP (IP Address, Setup menu) 134 Dialog (Option menu) 109 Dialog Lift (Dialogue, Option menu) 109 Dialog Lvl (Dialogue, Option menu) 109 Dialogue (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Dialogue (Option menu) 109 Dialogue Level (Dialogue, Option menu) 109 Dialogue Lift (Dialogue, Option menu) 109 Dialogue normalization level 143 Digital Media Controller (DMC) 113 Dimension (Sound Program menu) 119 Dimmer (Front Display) (Display Set, Setup menu) 139 Direct (Sound Program menu) 118 Direct Stream Digital (DSD) 162 Display Set (Function, Setup menu) 139 Distance (Speaker, Setup menu) 127 Distance (YPAO measurement result) 56 DLNA 89 DMC (Digital Media Controller) 113 DMC Control (Input menu) 113 DNS Server (IP Address, Setup menu) 134 DNS Server (Network, Information menu) 143 Dolby Digital EX (Extended Surround) 130 Dolby Pro Logic (surround decoder) 74 Dolby Pro Logic II (surround decoder) 74 Dolby Pro Logic IIx (surround decoder) 74 Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie (Extended Surround) Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music (Extended Surround) Drama (sound program) 71 DSD (Direct Stream Digital) 162 DSP Level (Sound Program menu) 117 DSP Program (front display information) 106 DTS Neo:6 (surround decoder) 74 DTS-ES (Extended Surround) 130 Dynamic Range (Sound, Setup menu) 129 130 130 E ECO (Setup menu) 141 ECO Mode (ECO, Setup menu) 141 Edge Enhancement (Video Mode, Setup menu) 132 Enhancer (Option menu) 109 ENHANCER (sound mode) 75 ENTERTAINMENT (sound program subcategory) 72 Error indication (front display) 161 EX/ES (Extended Surround, Setup menu) 130 Extended Surround (Sound, Setup menu) 130 External device control (remote control) 148 External power amplifier 33 Extra Bass (Subwoofer/Bass, Option menu) 109 F Filter (MAC Address Filter, Setup menu) 135 FIRM UPDATE (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 147 Firmware update 147 Firmware update (network) 147 Firmware update (USB) 147 Firmware Version (System, Information menu) 144 Firmware version check 147 FM Mode (Option menu) 111 FM radio listening 76 FM/AM radio tuning 76 Format (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Frequency (FM/AM radio) 76 Frequency step setting 76, 146 Front (Speaker, Setup menu) 125 Front / Rear Balance (Sound Program menu) 118 Front 5.1-channel system 21 Front display (part names and functions) 13 Front display brightness 139 Front display information 106 Front panel (part names and functions) 11 Front panel door (front panel) 11 Front Presence (Speaker, Setup menu) 126 Function (Setup menu) 138 G Ground lead 40 H Hall in Amsterdam (sound program) 72 Hall in Munich (sound program) 72 Hall in Vienna (sound program) 72 HD Radio™ information 78 HD Radio™ tuning 78 HDMI (Setup menu) 132 HDMI Control (HDMI, Setup menu) 132 HDMI Monitor (Information menu) 143 HDMI OUT1 (Audio Output, Setup menu) 133 HDMI OUT2 (Audio Output, Setup menu) 133 HDMI OUT2 Assign (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 138 HDMI output selection 67 HDMI signal compatibility 170 Headphones 73 Height (YPAO measurement result) 56 Height Balance (Sound Program menu) 118 High definition audio 170 Hi-Res Mode (Enhancer, Option menu) 109 HiRes Mode (Enhancer, Option menu) 109 HTC Connect 165 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 178 I In.Trim (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 Indicator (part names and functions) 13 Information display (front display) 13 Information menu 142 Information switching (front display) 106 Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) 117 Initial Volume (Sound, Setup menu) 130 Initial Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 136 Initial Volume (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 136 INITIALIZE (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 147 Input (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Input Assignment (Function, Setup menu) 138 Input jack assignment 138 Input menu 112 Input Settings (Option menu) 110 Input Trim (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 Internal Error (error indication) 161 Internal Error (YPAO error message) 57 Internet radio listening 92 IP Address (Network, Information menu) 143 IP Address (Network, Setup menu) 134 iPod charge 83 iPod content playback 83 iPod content playback (AirPlay) 95 iTunes content playback (AirPlay) 95 L Language (Setup menu) 142 Layout (Speaker, Setup menu) 126 Left / Right Balance (Sound Program menu) 118 Level (Sound Program menu) 118 Level (Speaker, Setup menu) 127 Level (YPAO measurement result) 56 Level Error (YPAO warning message) 58 LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 163 Lipsync 163 Lipsync (Sound, Setup menu) 129 LIVE/CLUB (sound program subcategory) 73 Liveness (Sound Program menu) 118 Load (Scene menu) 115 Low Frequency Effects (LFE) Muting 163 M MAC Address (MAC Address Filter, Setup menu) 135 MAC Address (Network, Information menu) 143 MAC Address Filter (Network, Setup menu) 135 Main Zone Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 136 Manual Setting (Wireless (Wi-Fi), Setup menu) 63 Manual Setup (Speaker, Setup menu) 124 Manual speaker configuration 124 Manual station preset (FM/AM radio) 77 Max Volume (Sound, Setup menu) 129 Max Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 136 Max Volume (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 136 Measurement result (YPAO) 55 Media sharing setup 89 Memory Guard (Function, Setup menu) 140 Menu language selection 46 MHL Overloaded (error indication) 161 MHL-compatible mobile device 41 Microphone base 50, 54 Monaural Mix (Sound Program menu) 118 Monaural reception (FM radio) 76 Monitor check 146 MONITOR CHECK (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 146 Monitor Out Assign (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 137 Mono (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 137 Mono (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 137 Mono Movie (sound program) 71 MOVIE (sound program category) 71 MOVIE THEATER (sound program subcategory) 71 Multi measurement (YPAO) 53 Multi Zone (Information menu) 144 Multi Zone (Setup menu) 136 Multiple room playback 97 Multi-zone 97 Multi-zone output 167 MUSIC (sound program category) 72 Music Video (sound program) 72 67 N NAS (Network Attached Storage) 43 NAS content playback 90 Network (Information menu) 143 Network (Setup menu) 134 Network Attached Storage (NAS) 43 Network Connection (Network, Information menu) 143 Network Connection (Network, Setup menu) 134 Network information 143 Network Name (Network, Information menu) 143 Network Name (Network, Setup menu) 135 Network Standby (Network, Setup menu) 134 No content (error indication) 161 No device (error indication) 161 No F.PRNS SP (YPAO error message) 57 No Front SP (YPAO error message) 57 No MIC (YPAO error message) 57 No R.PRNS SP (YPAO error message) 57 No Signal (YPAO error message) 57 No Sur. SP (YPAO error message) 57 Noisy (YPAO error message) 57 NTSC (TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP menu) 146 O Option menu 107 Out of Phase (YPAO warning message) 58 Output (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Over Distance (YPAO warning message) 58 P PAL (TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP menu) 146 Panorama (Sound Program menu) 119 Parametric EQ (Speaker, Setup menu) 127 Party mode 102 Party Mode Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 138 PC content playback 90 PIN Code (Wireless (Wi-Fi), Setup menu) 64 Playback device operation (remote control) 149 Please wait (error indication) 161 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 179 Power Amp Assign (Speaker, Setup menu) 124 Power management 141 Power Mode (DC OUT, Setup menu) 140 Preset station selection (FM/AM radio) 77 Program Service (Radio Data System) 80 Program Type (Radio Data System) 80 Pure Direct 75 PURE DIRECT (sound mode) 75 Pure Direct Mode (Sound, Setup menu) 130 Reset (remote control) 150 Reset (Scene menu) 116 Resolution (Video Mode, Setup menu) 131 Reverb Delay (Sound Program menu) 118 Reverb Level (Sound Program menu) 118 Reverb Time (Sound Program menu) 118 Reverse (Wiring, YPAO measurement result) Roleplaying Game (sound program) 72 Room Size (Sound Program menu) 117 Q S Q factor 128 R Radio Data System information 80 Radio Data System tuning 80 Radio Text (Radio Data System) 80 Rear panel (part names and functions) 14 Rear Presence (Speaker, Setup menu) 126 Recital/Opera (sound program) 72 RECOV./BACKUP (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 147 RemID Mismatch (error indication) 161 REMOTE CON AMP (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 145 Remote control (part names and functions) 16 Remote control code registration (playback device) 149 Remote control code registration (TV) 148 Remote Control Code Search 148, 149 Remote control ID setting 145 Remote control sensor setting 145 Remote ID (System, Information menu) 144 Remote Off (error indication) 161 REMOTE SENSOR (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 145 Rename (input name) 113 Rename (network name) 135 Rename (scene name) 115 Rename/Icon Select (Input menu) 113 Rename/Icon Select (Scene menu) 115 Repeat (iPod, Option menu) 85 Repeat (PC/NAS, Option menu) 91 Repeat (USB storage device, Option menu) 88 56 Sampling (Audio Signal, Information menu) 143 Saturation (Video Mode, Setup menu) 132 Save (Scene menu) 114 SBR → SBL (YPAO error message) 57 Scene configuration 69 SCENE function 68 SCENE link playback 69 Scene menu 114 Sci-Fi (sound program) 71 Security (Network, Information menu) 143 Security Key (Network, Information menu) 143 Setting Data Copy (Speaker, Setup menu) 124 Setting Pattern (Speaker, Setup menu) 124 Setup menu 120 Share Wi-Fi Settings (iOS) (Wireless (Wi-Fi), Setup menu) 60 Short Message (Display Set, Setup menu) 139 Shuffle (iPod, Option menu) 85 Shuffle (PC/NAS, Option menu) 91 Shuffle (USB storage device, Option menu) 88 Signal information 143 SILENT CINEMA 73 Simple play (iPod) 85 Single measurement (YPAO) 50 Size (YPAO measurement result) 56 Sleep timer 16 Sleep timer (Zone2/Zone3/Zone4) 102 Sound (Setup menu) 129 Sound field effect 71 Sound mode selection 70 Sound program 71, 72 Sound Program menu 116 Speaker (Setup menu) 124 SPEAKER IMP. (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 145 Speaker impedance 18 Speaker Impedance (System, Information menu) 144 Speaker impedance setting 22, 145 Speaker placement 19 Spectacle (sound program) 71 Sports (sound program) 72 SSID 164 SSID (Network, Information menu) 143 Standard (sound program) 71 Standby Sync (HDMI Control, Setup menu) 133 Standby Through (HDMI, Setup menu) 133 Station Info (HD Radio™) 78 Station preset (FM/AM radio) 77 STEREO (sound program subcategory) 73 Stereo reception (FM radio) 76 STRAIGHT (sound mode) 74 Straight decode 74 Subnet Mask (IP Address, Setup menu) 134 Subnet Mask (Network, Information menu) 143 Subwoofer 1 (Speaker, Setup menu) 126 Subwoofer 2 (Speaker, Setup menu) 126 Subwoofer Trim (Subwoofer/Bass, Option menu) 109 Subwoofer/Bass (Option menu) 109 SUR.DECODE (sound mode) 74 Surround (Speaker, Setup menu) 125 Surround Back (Speaker, Setup menu) 125 Surround Back Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) 117 Surround Back Liveness (Sound Program menu) 118 Surround Back Room Size (Sound Program menu) 117 Surround decoder 74 Surround Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) 117 Surround Liveness (Sound Program menu) 118 Surround Room Size (Sound Program menu) 117 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 180 SW.Trim (Subwoofer/Bass, Option menu) 109 System (Information menu) 144 System ID (System, Information menu) 144 T Target Zone (Trigger Output, Setup menu) 140 Test Tone (Speaker, Setup menu) 128 The Bottom Line (sound program) 73 The Roxy Theatre (sound program) 73 Tone Control (Option menu) 108 TP (Traffic Program) 81 Traffic information (Radio Data System) 81 Traffic Program (FM radio, Option menu) 81 Treble (Tone Control, Option menu) 108 Trigger function 45 Trigger Mode (Trigger Output, Setup menu) 139 Trigger Output1 (Function, Setup menu) 139 Trigger Output2 (Function, Setup menu) 139 TUNER FRQ STEP (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 146 Tuner Frq. Step (System, Information menu) 144 TV Audio Input (HDMI Control, Setup menu) 132 TV FORMAT (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 146 TV Format (System, Information menu) 144 TV operation (remote control) 148 U Unable to play (error indication) 161 USB Overloaded (error indication) 161 USB storage device content playback 86 User Cancel (YPAO error message) 57 V V.M (Video Processing, Option menu) 110 V.Out (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 VERSION (ADVANCED SETUP menu) 147 Version error (error indication) 161 Video (Setup menu) 131 Video Adjust (Video Processing, Option menu) 110 Video Adjustment (Video Processing, Option menu) 110 Video Mode (Video Processing, Option menu) 110 Video Mode (Video, Setup menu) 131 Video Out (Input Settings, Option menu) 110 Video Process. (Option menu) 110 Video Processing (Option menu) 110 Video Signal (Information menu) 143 Video signal flow 166 Video signal type setting 146 Village Vanguard (sound program) 73 Virtual CINEMA DSP 73 Virtual CINEMA FRONT 73 Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) 20, 21 Voltage selection 45 Volume (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 136 Volume (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 136 Volume Interlock (Input menu) 113 VPS (Sound, Setup menu) 130 VPS (Virtual Presence Speaker) 20, 21 YPAO Vol. (YPAO Volume, Option menu) 108 YPAO Volume (Option menu) 108 YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume, Option menu) 108 YPAO warning message 58 Z Zone Rename (Main Zone Set, Setup menu) 136 Zone Rename (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone Rename (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone Rename (Zone4 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone Scene Rename (Zone2 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone Scene Rename (Zone3 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone Scene Rename (Zone4 Set, Setup menu) 137 Zone2 Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 136 Zone3 Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 136 Zone4 Set (Multi Zone, Setup menu) 137 W Wallpaper (Display Set, Setup menu) 139 Warehouse Loft (sound program) 73 Web control 103 Wi-Fi 164 Wired (Network Connection, Setup menu) 134 Wired/Wireless (Network, Information menu) 143 Wireless (Wi-Fi) (Network Connection, Setup menu) 60, 134 Wireless Direct (Network Connection, Setup menu) 65, 134 Wiring (YPAO measurement result) 56 WPS 164 WPS Button (Wireless (Wi-Fi), Setup menu) 62 WPS button configuration 61 Y Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) 47 YPAO (Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer) YPAO error message 57 YPAO microphone 47 47 APPENDIX ➤ Index En 181 © 2014 Yamaha Corporation YG260B0/EN
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : Yes Encryption : Standard V2.3 (128-bit) User Access : Print, Extract, Print high-res XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 5.2-c001 63.139439, 2010/09/27-13:37:26 Format : application/pdf Title : Description : Creator : Subject : Keywords : Modify Date : 2014:06:12 14:44:23+09:00 Create Date : 2014:06:12 14:44:23+09:00 Metadata Date : 2014:06:12 14:44:23+09:00 Document ID : uuid:9a3d928f-7f2f-43c8-9a1b-a4153a5b329e Instance ID : uuid:383d6781-5690-478d-9d6b-bbfc561fd751 Page Mode : UseOutlines Page Count : 182EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools